blob: e54c88fc054b1d20f08330f1614094e29247a446 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Chandler Carruthaa36b892015-12-30 03:40:23 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclContextInternals.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000024#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000025#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000027#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000028#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000029#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000031#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000032#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000033#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000034#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000035#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000036#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000039#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000040#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000041#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000042#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000043
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000044using namespace clang;
45
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000046unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000048unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000050unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000052unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000054unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000056unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000059enum FloatingRank {
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +000060 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank, Float128Rank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000061};
62
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000063RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000064 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +000066
67#ifndef NDEBUG
68 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71#endif
72
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000073 CommentsLoaded = true;
74 }
75
76 assert(D);
77
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000078 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000080 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000081
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000082 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000085 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000086 }
87
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000088 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000091 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000092 }
93
94 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000096 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000097 }
98
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000099 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000104 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000105 }
106
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000107 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000109 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000110 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000111 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000115 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000116 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000117 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000119 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000120
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000121 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122 // documentation.
123 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000126 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000127
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000128 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000129
130 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000132 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000133
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000134 // Find declaration location.
135 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137 // location".
138 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000142 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000143 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000146 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000147 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000148 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152 // the "declaration location".
153 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
158 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163 }
164 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000165 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000166
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000169 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000170 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000171
172 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000173 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174 {
175 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000178 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000181 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187 }
188
189 if (Found) {
190 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193 } else {
194 // Slow path.
195 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197 }
198 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000199
200 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201 // file buffer.
202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203
204 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000206 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000207 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000208 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000209 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000210 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000211 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000217 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000218 }
219 }
220
221 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222 // Let's look at the previous comment.
223 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000224 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000225 --Comment;
226
227 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000228 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000229 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000230
231 // Decompose the end of the comment.
232 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000233 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000234
235 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236 // aren't related.
237 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000238 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000239
240 // Get the corresponding buffer.
241 bool Invalid = false;
242 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243 &Invalid).data();
244 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000245 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000246
247 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000251 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000253 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000254 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000255
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000257}
258
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000259namespace {
260/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000262/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000263const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000264 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000265 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000266 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000267 return FTD;
268
269 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271 return D;
272
273 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275 return FTD;
276
277 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280 return MemberDecl;
281
282 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000283 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000284 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286 // template?
287 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289 return MemberDecl;
290
291 return D;
292 }
293 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296 return CTD;
297
298 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299 // specialization?
300 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303 return D;
304 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(
310 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311 }
312
313 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317
318 return D;
319 }
320 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323 return MemberDecl;
324
325 return D;
326 }
327 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000328 return D;
329}
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +0000330} // anonymous namespace
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000331
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000332const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333 const Decl *D,
334 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000335 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000336
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000337 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338 {
339 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340 RedeclComments.find(D);
341 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000343 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344 if (OriginalDecl)
345 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000346 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000347 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000348 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000349 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000350
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000351 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000352 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000354 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000355 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000356 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000357 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000361 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000362 break;
363 }
364 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000365 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368 if (RC) {
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000369 // Call order swapped to work around ICE in VS2015 RTM (Release Win32)
370 // https://connect.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/feedback/details/1741530
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000371 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000372 Raw.setRaw(RC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000373 } else
374 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000375 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
376 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000377 if (RC)
378 break;
379 }
380 }
381
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000382 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
383 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000384
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000385 if (OriginalDecl)
386 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
387
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000388 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
389 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
390 Raw.setRaw(RC);
391 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000392 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000393
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000394 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
395 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000396 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
397 R = Raw;
398 }
399
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000400 return RC;
401}
402
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000403static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
404 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
405 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
406 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
407 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
408 if (!ID)
409 return;
410 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000411 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000412 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000413 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000414 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
415 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
416 }
417 }
418}
419
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000420comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
421 const Decl *D) const {
422 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
423 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
424 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
425 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
426 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000427 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
428 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000429 comments::FullComment *CFC =
430 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
431 ThisDeclInfo);
432 return CFC;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000433}
434
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000435comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
436 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000437 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000438}
439
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000440comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
441 const Decl *D,
442 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000443 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000444 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000445 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000446
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000447 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
448 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
449 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000450
451 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000452 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000453 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000454 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000455 return CFC;
456 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000457 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000458 }
459
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000460 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000461
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000462 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000463 if (!RC) {
464 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000465 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000466 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000467 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
468 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
469 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
470 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000471 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000472 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
473 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000474 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
475 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
476 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000477 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000478 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000479 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000480 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000481 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000482 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
483 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
484 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000485 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000486 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000487 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
488 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
489 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
490 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
491 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
492 }
493 }
494 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
495 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
496 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
497 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
498 }
499 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
500 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000501 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000502 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000503 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
504 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000505 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000506 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000507 if (Ty.isNull())
508 continue;
509 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
510 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
511 continue;
512
513 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
514 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
515 }
516 }
517 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000518 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
519 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000520 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000521 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000522 if (Ty.isNull())
523 continue;
524 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
525 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
526 continue;
527 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
528 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
529 }
530 }
531 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000532 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000533 }
534
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000535 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
536 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
537 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
538 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000539 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000540 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000541
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000542 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000543 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
544 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000545}
546
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000547void
548ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
549 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
550 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
551 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000552 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000553
554 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
555 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
556 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
557 PEnd = Params->end();
558 P != PEnd; ++P) {
559 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
560 ID.AddInteger(0);
561 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
562 continue;
563 }
564
565 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
566 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000567 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000568 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000569 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
570 ID.AddBoolean(true);
571 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000572 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
573 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
574 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
575 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000576 } else
577 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000578 continue;
579 }
580
581 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
582 ID.AddInteger(2);
583 Profile(ID, TTP);
584 }
585}
586
587TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
588ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000589 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000590 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
591 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
592 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000593 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000594 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
595 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
596 if (Canonical)
597 return Canonical->getParam();
598
599 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
600 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000601 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000602 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
603 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
604 PEnd = Params->end();
605 P != PEnd; ++P) {
606 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
607 CanonParams.push_back(
608 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000609 SourceLocation(),
610 SourceLocation(),
611 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000612 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000613 TTP->isParameterPack()));
614 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000615 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
616 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
617 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
618 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
619 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000620 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
621 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000622 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
623 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
624 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
625 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
626 }
627
628 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000629 SourceLocation(),
630 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000631 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000632 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000633 T,
634 TInfo,
David Majnemerdfecf1a2016-07-06 04:19:16 +0000635 ExpandedTypes,
636 ExpandedTInfos);
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000637 } else {
638 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000639 SourceLocation(),
640 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000641 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000642 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000643 T,
644 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645 TInfo);
646 }
647 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648
649 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652 }
653
654 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
655 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
656 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000657 TTP->getPosition(),
658 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000659 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000660 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
661 SourceLocation(),
David Majnemer902f8c62015-12-27 07:16:27 +0000662 CanonParams,
Hubert Tong286547a2016-07-20 01:05:31 +0000663 SourceLocation()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000664
665 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
666 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000667 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000668 (void)Canonical;
669
670 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
671 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
672 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
673 return CanonTTP;
674}
675
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000676CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000677 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000678
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000679 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000680 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000681 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000682 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +0000683 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000684 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +0000685 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000686 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +0000687 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000688 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000689 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000690 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
691 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000692 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000693}
694
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000695static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000696 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
697 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
698 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
699 // language-specific address space.
700 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
701 1, // opencl_global
702 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000703 3, // opencl_constant
Anastasia Stulova2c8dcfb2014-11-26 14:10:06 +0000704 4, // opencl_generic
705 5, // cuda_device
706 6, // cuda_constant
707 7 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000708 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000709 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000710 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000711 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000712 }
713}
714
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000715static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
716 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
717 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000718 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
719 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
720 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
721 return true;
722 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
723 return false;
724 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000725 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000726}
727
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000728ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000729 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000730 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000731 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
732 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
733 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
734 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr), Int128Decl(nullptr),
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +0000735 UInt128Decl(nullptr), BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr),
736 BuiltinMSVaListDecl(nullptr), ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr),
737 ObjCClassDecl(nullptr), ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +0000738 CFConstantStringTagDecl(nullptr), CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr),
739 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr), FILEDecl(nullptr), jmp_bufDecl(nullptr),
740 sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr), ucontext_tDecl(nullptr),
741 BlockDescriptorType(nullptr), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr),
742 cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr), FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Eric Fiselier6ad68552016-07-01 01:24:09 +0000743 ExternCContext(nullptr), MakeIntegerSeqDecl(nullptr),
744 TypePackElementDecl(nullptr), SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Alexey Samsonova511cdd2015-02-04 17:40:08 +0000745 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000746 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), AuxTarget(nullptr),
747 PrintingPolicy(LOpts), Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
748 BuiltinInfo(builtins), DeclarationNames(*this), ExternalSource(nullptr),
749 Listener(nullptr), Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000750 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000751 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
752}
753
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000754ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000755 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
756
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000757 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
758 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
759 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000760
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000761 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000762 for (auto &Pair : Deallocations)
763 (Pair.first)(Pair.second);
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000764
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000765 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000766 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
767 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
768 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
769 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
770 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
771 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
772 R->Destroy(*this);
773
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000774 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
775 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
776 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
777 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
778 R->Destroy(*this);
779 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000780
781 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
782 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
783 A != AEnd; ++A)
784 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000785
David Majnemere694f3e2015-08-14 14:43:50 +0000786 for (std::pair<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue *> &MTVPair :
787 MaterializedTemporaryValues)
788 MTVPair.second->~APValue();
789
Reid Kleckner588c9372014-02-19 23:44:52 +0000790 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000791}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000792
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000793void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +0000794 if (!PointerParents) return;
795 for (const auto &Entry : *PointerParents) {
796 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
797 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
798 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
799 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
800 }
801 }
802 for (const auto &Entry : *OtherParents) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000803 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
804 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +0000805 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000806 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
807 }
808 }
809}
810
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000811void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000812 Deallocations.push_back({Callback, Data});
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000813}
814
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000815void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000816ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
Benjamin Kramerd6da1a02016-06-12 20:05:23 +0000817 ExternalSource = std::move(Source);
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000818}
819
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000820void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000821 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
822 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000823
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000824 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000825#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000826#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
827#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
828 0 // Extra
829 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000830
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000831 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
832 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000833 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000834 }
835
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000836 unsigned Idx = 0;
837 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
838#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
839 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000840 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
841 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000842 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
843 ++Idx;
844#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
845#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000846
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000847 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
848
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000849 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000850 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
851 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
852 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
853 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
854 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
855 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000856 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000857 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
858 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
859 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
860 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
861 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
862 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000863 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000864 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
865 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
866 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
867 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
868 << NumImplicitDestructors
869 << " implicit destructors created\n";
870
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000871 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000872 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000873 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
874 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000875
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000876 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000877}
878
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000879void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
880 bool NotifyListeners) {
881 if (NotifyListeners)
882 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
883 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
884
885 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
886 MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M);
887 else
888 ND->setHidden(false);
889}
890
891void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
892 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND);
893 if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
894 return;
895
896 auto &Merged = It->second;
897 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
898 for (Module *&M : Merged)
899 if (!Found.insert(M).second)
900 M = nullptr;
901 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
902}
903
Richard Smithf19e1272015-03-07 00:04:49 +0000904ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
905 if (!ExternCContext)
906 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
907
908 return ExternCContext;
909}
910
David Majnemerd9b1a4f2015-11-04 03:40:30 +0000911BuiltinTemplateDecl *
912ASTContext::buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK,
913 const IdentifierInfo *II) const {
914 auto *BuiltinTemplate = BuiltinTemplateDecl::Create(*this, TUDecl, II, BTK);
915 BuiltinTemplate->setImplicit();
916 TUDecl->addDecl(BuiltinTemplate);
917
918 return BuiltinTemplate;
919}
920
921BuiltinTemplateDecl *
922ASTContext::getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const {
923 if (!MakeIntegerSeqDecl)
924 MakeIntegerSeqDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__make_integer_seq,
925 getMakeIntegerSeqName());
926 return MakeIntegerSeqDecl;
927}
928
Eric Fiselier6ad68552016-07-01 01:24:09 +0000929BuiltinTemplateDecl *
930ASTContext::getTypePackElementDecl() const {
931 if (!TypePackElementDecl)
932 TypePackElementDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__type_pack_element,
933 getTypePackElementName());
934 return TypePackElementDecl;
935}
936
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000937RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
938 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000939 SourceLocation Loc;
940 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000941 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
942 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
943 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000944 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000945 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
946 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000947 NewDecl->setImplicit();
David Majnemerf8637362015-01-15 08:41:25 +0000948 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
949 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000950 return NewDecl;
951}
952
953TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
954 StringRef Name) const {
955 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
956 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
957 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
958 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
959 NewDecl->setImplicit();
960 return NewDecl;
961}
962
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000963TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000964 if (!Int128Decl)
965 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000966 return Int128Decl;
967}
968
969TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000970 if (!UInt128Decl)
971 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000972 return UInt128Decl;
973}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000974
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000975void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000976 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000977 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000978 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000979}
980
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000981void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target,
982 const TargetInfo *AuxTarget) {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000983 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
984 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000985 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000986
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000987 this->Target = &Target;
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000988 this->AuxTarget = AuxTarget;
989
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000990 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
991 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000992 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000993
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000994 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000995 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000996
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000997 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000998 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000999 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +00001000 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +00001001 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
1002 else
1003 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001004 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001005 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
1006 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
1007 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
1008 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
1009 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001010
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001011 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001012 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
1013 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
1014 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
1015 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
1016 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001017
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001018 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001019 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
1020 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
1021 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001022
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001023 // GNU extension, __float128 for IEEE quadruple precision
1024 InitBuiltinType(Float128Ty, BuiltinType::Float128);
1025
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00001026 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
1027 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
1028 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
1029
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +00001030 // C++ 3.9.1p5
1031 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
1032 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1033 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1034 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1035 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1036 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1037 else {
1038 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1039 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1040 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001041
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +00001042 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1043
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001044 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1045 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
1046 else // C99
1047 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1048
1049 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1050 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
1051 else // C99
1052 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1053
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001054 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1055 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1056 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1057 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1058 // expressions.
1059 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001060
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00001061 // Placeholder type for functions.
1062 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1063
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001064 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1065 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1066
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001067 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1068 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1069
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001070 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1071 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1072
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001073 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1074 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1075
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001076 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1077 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1078
Alexey Bataev1a3320e2015-08-25 14:24:04 +00001079 // Placeholder type for OMP array sections.
1080 if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
1081 InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection);
1082
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001083 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001084 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1085 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1086 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001087 Float128ComplexTy = getComplexType(Float128Ty);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001088
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001089 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001090 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1091 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001092 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001093
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00001094 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1095#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1096 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00001097#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001098
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001099 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001100 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001101 InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
1102 InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
1103 InitBuiltinType(OCLNDRangeTy, BuiltinType::OCLNDRange);
1104 InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001105 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001106
1107 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001108 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1109 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001110
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001111 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001112
1113 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001114
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001115 // void * type
1116 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001117
1118 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1119 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001120
1121 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1122 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001123
1124 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00001125 VaListTagDecl = nullptr;
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001126}
1127
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001128DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001129 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1130}
1131
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001132AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1133 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1134 if (!Result) {
1135 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1136 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1137 }
1138
1139 return *Result;
1140}
1141
1142/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1143void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1144 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1145 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1146 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1147 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1148 }
1149}
1150
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001151// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001152MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001153ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001154 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001155 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1156 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1157}
1158
1159ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1160ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1161 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1162 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1163 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1164 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001165
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001166 return Pos->second;
1167}
1168
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001169void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001170ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001171 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1172 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001173 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1174 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001175 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1176 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1177}
1178
1179void
1180ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1181 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1182 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1183 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1184 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001185}
1186
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001187FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1188 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1189 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1190 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001191 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1192 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001193 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001194
1195 return Pos->second;
1196}
1197
1198void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1199 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1200 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1201 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001202 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001203}
1204
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001205NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001206ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001207 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001208 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1209 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001210 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001211
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001212 return Pos->second;
1213}
1214
1215void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001216ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1217 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1218 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1219 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1220 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1221 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1222 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1223}
1224
1225UsingShadowDecl *
1226ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1227 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1228 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1229 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001230 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001231
1232 return Pos->second;
1233}
1234
1235void
1236ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1237 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1238 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1239 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001240}
1241
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001242FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1243 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1244 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1245 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001246 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001247
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001248 return Pos->second;
1249}
1250
1251void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1252 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1253 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1254 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1255 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1256 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001257
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001258 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1259}
1260
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001261ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1262ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001263 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1264 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001265 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001266 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001267 return Pos->second.begin();
1268}
1269
1270ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1271ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001272 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1273 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001274 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001275 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001276 return Pos->second.end();
1277}
1278
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001279unsigned
1280ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001281 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1282 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001283 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1284 return 0;
Chandler Carruthb1bcd5d2016-06-11 04:45:38 +00001285 return Pos->second.size();
Clement Courbet8251ebf2016-06-10 11:54:43 +00001286}
1287
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001288ASTContext::overridden_method_range
1289ASTContext::overridden_methods(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1290 return overridden_method_range(overridden_methods_begin(Method),
1291 overridden_methods_end(Method));
1292}
1293
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001294void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1295 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001296 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001297 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1298}
1299
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001300void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1301 const NamedDecl *D,
1302 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001303 assert(D);
1304
1305 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001306 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1307 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001308 return;
1309 }
1310
1311 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1312 if (!Method)
1313 return;
1314
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001315 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1316 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001317 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001318}
1319
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001320void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1321 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1322 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1323 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1324 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1325 LastLocalImport = Import;
1326 return;
1327 }
1328
1329 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1330 LastLocalImport = Import;
1331}
1332
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001333//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1334// Type Sizing and Analysis
1335//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001336
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001337/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1338/// scalar floating point type.
1339const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001340 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001341 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1342 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001343 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001344 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001345 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1346 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1347 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001348 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Target->getFloat128Format();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001349 }
1350}
1351
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001352CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001353 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001354
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001355 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1356 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1357 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001358
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001359 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1360 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1361 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1362 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001363 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001364 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1365 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1366 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1367 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1368 } else {
1369 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1370 }
1371 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001372 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1373 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1374 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1375 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001376
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001377 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1378 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001379 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001380 // do nothing
1381
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001382 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001383 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001384 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001385 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001386 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1387 else
1388 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1389 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001390 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1391 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001392 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1393 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001394 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001395 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1396 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001397 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1398 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1399 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1400 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1401 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1402 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001403 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001404 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001405 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Ulrich Weigandb63f7792015-04-21 17:26:18 +00001406 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001407 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1408 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001409 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001410
1411 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1412 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1413 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1414 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1415 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001416 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1417 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1418 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1419 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1420 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001421
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001422 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1423 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001424
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001425 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1426 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1427 if (Offset > 0) {
1428 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1429 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1430 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1431 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1432 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1433 }
1434
1435 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001436 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001437 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001438 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001439
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001440 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001441}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001442
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001443// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1444// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1445// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1446// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1447std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1448ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1449 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1450
1451 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1452 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1453 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1454 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1455 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1456 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1457 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1458 }
1459 }
1460
1461 return sizeAndAlign;
1462}
1463
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001464/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1465/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1466std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1467static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1468 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1469 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1470 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1471 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001472 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1473 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001474 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1475 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1476 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001477 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1478 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001479 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001480 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1481 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1482}
1483
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001484std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001485ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001486 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1487 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001488 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1489 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1490 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001491}
1492
1493std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001494ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001495 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1496}
1497
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001498bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1499 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1500}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001501
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001502bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1503 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1504}
1505
1506TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemerf8d38642014-07-30 08:42:33 +00001507 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1508 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1509 return I->second;
1510
1511 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1512 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1513 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
Rafael Espindolaeaa88c12014-07-30 04:40:23 +00001514 return TI;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001515}
1516
1517/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1518/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001519///
1520/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1521/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1522/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001523TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1524 uint64_t Width = 0;
1525 unsigned Align = 8;
1526 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001527 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001528#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1529#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001530#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001531#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001532#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1533 case Type::Class: \
1534 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1535 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001536#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001537 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001538
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001539 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1540 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001541 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1542 Width = 0;
1543 Align = 32;
1544 break;
1545
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001546 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001547 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001548 Width = 0;
1549 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1550 break;
1551
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001552 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001553 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001554
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001555 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001556 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001557 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001558 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001559 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1560 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001561 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1562 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001563 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001564 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001565 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001566 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001567 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001568 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001569 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1570 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001571 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001572 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1573 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001574 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001575 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001576 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001577 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001578 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1579 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1580 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1581 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001582 break;
1583 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001584
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001585 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001586 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001587 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001588 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001589 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1590 Width = 0;
1591 Align = 8;
1592 break;
1593
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001594 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001595 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1596 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001597 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001598 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1599 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1600 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001601 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001602 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1603 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001604 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001605 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1606 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001607 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1608 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001609 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001610 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001611 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1612 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001613 break;
1614 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001615 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1616 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001617 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001618 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001619 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001620 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1621 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001622 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001623 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001624 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001625 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1626 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001627 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001628 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001629 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001630 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1631 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001632 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001633 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001634 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001635 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1636 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001637 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001638 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1639 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1640 Width = 128;
1641 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1642 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001643 case BuiltinType::Half:
1644 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1645 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1646 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001647 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001648 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1649 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001650 break;
1651 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001652 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1653 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001654 break;
1655 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001656 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1657 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001658 break;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001659 case BuiltinType::Float128:
1660 Width = Target->getFloat128Width();
1661 Align = Target->getFloat128Align();
1662 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001663 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001664 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1665 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001666 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001667 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1668 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1669 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001670 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1671 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001672 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001673 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1674 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1675 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1676 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1677 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001678 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001679 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
1680 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
1681 case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange:
1682 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00001683#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1684 case BuiltinType::Id:
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00001685#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00001686
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001687 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1688 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1689 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1690 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001691 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001692 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001693 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001694 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1695 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001696 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001697 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001698 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1699 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001700 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1701 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001702 break;
1703 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001704 case Type::LValueReference:
1705 case Type::RValueReference: {
1706 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1707 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001708 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1709 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001710 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1711 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001712 break;
1713 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001714 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001715 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001716 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1717 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001718 break;
1719 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001720 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001721 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001722 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001723 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001724 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001725 case Type::Complex: {
1726 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1727 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001728 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1729 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1730 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001731 break;
1732 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001733 case Type::ObjCObject:
1734 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001735 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001736 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001737 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001738 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001739 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001740 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001741 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001742 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001743 break;
1744 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001745 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001746 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001747 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1748
1749 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001750 Width = 8;
1751 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001752 break;
1753 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001754
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001755 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1756 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1757 TypeInfo Info =
1758 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1759 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1760 Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1761 Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1762 }
1763 return Info;
1764 }
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001765
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001766 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001767 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1768 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001769 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001770 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001771 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001772 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001773 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001774
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001775 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001776 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1777 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001778
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001779 case Type::Auto: {
1780 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001781 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1782 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001783 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001784 }
1785
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001786 case Type::Paren:
1787 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1788
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001789 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001790 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001791 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001792 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1793 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1794 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001795 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001796 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001797 AlignIsRequired = true;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001798 } else {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001799 Align = Info.Align;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001800 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1801 }
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001802 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001803 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001804 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001805
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001806 case Type::Elaborated:
1807 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001808
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001809 case Type::Attributed:
1810 return getTypeInfo(
1811 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1812
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001813 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001814 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001815 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1816 Width = Info.Width;
1817 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001818
1819 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1820 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1821 // favorable to atomic operations:
1822 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1823 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1824 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1825 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1826
1827 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001828 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1829 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001830 }
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00001831 break;
1832
1833 case Type::Pipe: {
1834 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<PipeType>(T)->getElementType());
1835 Width = Info.Width;
1836 Align = Info.Align;
1837 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001838
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001839 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001840
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001841 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001842 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001843}
1844
Alexey Bataev00396512015-07-02 03:40:19 +00001845unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
1846 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
1847 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32.
1848 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 ||
1849 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) &&
1850 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" &&
1851 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
1852 SimdAlign = 256;
1853 return SimdAlign;
1854}
1855
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001856/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1857CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1858 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1859}
1860
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001861/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1862int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1863 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1864}
1865
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001866/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1867/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001868CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001869 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001870}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001871CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001872 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001873}
1874
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001875/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001876/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001877CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001878 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001879}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001880CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001881 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001882}
1883
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001884/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1885/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1886/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1887/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001888unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001889 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1890 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001891
David Majnemere1544562015-04-24 01:25:05 +00001892 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1893
1894 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
1895 if (T->isMemberPointerType())
1896 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
1897
Andrey Turetskiydb6655f2016-02-10 11:58:46 +00001898 if (!Target->allowsLargerPreferedTypeAlignment())
1899 return ABIAlign;
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001900
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001901 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00001902 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001903 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001904 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
1905 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001906 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001907 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1908 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001909 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1910 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001911 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001912 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001913
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001914 return ABIAlign;
1915}
1916
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00001917/// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
1918/// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
1919/// value is specified.
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00001920unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const {
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00001921 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
1922}
1923
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001924/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1925/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1926unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1927 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1928}
1929
1930/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1931/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1932CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1933 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1934}
1935
David Majnemer08ef2ba2015-06-23 20:34:18 +00001936CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
1937 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
1938 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
1939 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
1940 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
1941 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
1942 }
1943 return Offset;
1944}
1945
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001946/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1947/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1948/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1949/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1950/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001951///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001952void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1953 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001954 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001955 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1956 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1957 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00001958 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1959 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001960 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001961 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001962 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001963 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1964 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1965 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001966}
1967
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001968/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1969/// those inherited by it.
1970void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001971 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001972 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001973 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1974 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00001975 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00001976 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001977 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001978
1979 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00001980 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1981 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001982
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001983 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1984 while (SD) {
1985 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1986 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1987 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001988 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00001989 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00001990 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001991 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001992 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00001993 // Insert the protocol.
1994 if (!Protocols.insert(
1995 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
1996 return;
1997
1998 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
1999 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002000 }
2001}
2002
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002003unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002004 unsigned count = 0;
2005 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00002006 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002007 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002008
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002009 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
2010 // includes synthesized ivars.
2011 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002012 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
2013
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00002014 return count;
2015}
2016
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00002017bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
2018 if (!E)
2019 return false;
2020
2021 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
2022 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
2023
2024 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
2025 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
2026 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2027 return true;
2028
2029 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
2030 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
2031
2032 return false;
2033}
2034
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002035/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
2036ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
2037 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2038 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2039 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2040 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002041 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002042}
2043/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
2044ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
2045 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2046 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2047 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2048 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002049 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002050}
2051
2052/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
2053void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2054 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2055 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2056 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2057}
2058/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
2059void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2060 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2061 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2062 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2063}
2064
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00002065const ObjCMethodDecl *
2066ASTContext::getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) const {
2067 return ObjCMethodRedecls.lookup(MD);
2068}
2069
2070void ASTContext::setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD,
2071 const ObjCMethodDecl *Redecl) {
2072 assert(!getObjCMethodRedeclaration(MD) && "MD already has a redeclaration");
2073 ObjCMethodRedecls[MD] = Redecl;
2074}
2075
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002076const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2077 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2078 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
2079 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002080 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002081 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
2082 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002083 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002084 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
2085 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002086 return IMD->getClassInterface();
2087
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002088 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002089}
2090
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002091/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
2092/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002093Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002094 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2095 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2096 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002097 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002098 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002099 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002100}
2101
2102/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
2103void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
2104 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002105 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2106 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002107 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
2108}
2109
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002110TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002111 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002112 if (!DataSize)
2113 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2114 else
2115 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002116 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002117
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002118 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2119 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2120 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2121 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00002122}
2123
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002124TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00002125 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002126 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00002127 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00002128 return DI;
2129}
2130
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002131const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002132ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002133 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002134}
2135
2136const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002137ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2138 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002139 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2140}
2141
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002142//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2143// Type creation/memoization methods
2144//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2145
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002146QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002147ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2148 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2149 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002150
2151 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2152 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002153 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002154 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002155 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2156 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2157 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002158 }
2159
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002160 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2161 QualType canon;
2162 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2163 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002164 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2165 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002166
2167 // Re-find the insert position.
2168 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2169 }
2170
2171 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2172 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2173 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002174}
2175
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002176QualType
2177ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002178 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2179 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002180 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002181
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002182 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2183 // into one ExtQuals node.
2184 QualifierCollector Quals;
2185 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002186
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002187 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2188 // another one.
2189 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2190 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2191 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002192
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002193 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002194}
2195
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002196QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002197 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002198 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002199 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002200 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002201
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002202 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2203 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002204 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002205 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2206 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2207 }
2208 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002209
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002210 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2211 // into one ExtQuals node.
2212 QualifierCollector Quals;
2213 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002214
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002215 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2216 // another one.
2217 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2218 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2219 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002220
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002221 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002222}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002223
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002224const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2225 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2226 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2227 return T;
2228
2229 QualType Result;
2230 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002231 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002232 } else {
2233 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2234 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2235 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002236 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002237 }
2238
2239 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2240}
2241
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002242void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2243 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002244 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2245 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002246 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2247 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002248 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002249 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2250 FD = Next;
2251 else
2252 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002253 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002254 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2255 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002256}
2257
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002258/// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2259/// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2260/// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2261/// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
2262static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2263 ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2264 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2265 // Might have some parens.
2266 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2267 return Context.getParenType(
2268 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2269
2270 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2271 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2272 return Context.getAttributedType(
2273 AT->getAttrKind(),
2274 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2275 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2276 ESI));
2277
2278 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2279 // specification.
2280 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2281 return Context.getFunctionType(
2282 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2283 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2284}
2285
2286void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2287 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2288 bool AsWritten) {
2289 // Update the type.
2290 QualType Updated =
2291 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2292 FD->setType(Updated);
2293
2294 if (!AsWritten)
2295 return;
2296
2297 // Update the type in the type source information too.
2298 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2299 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2300 // the type-as-written too.
2301 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2302 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2303
2304 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2305 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2306 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2307 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2308 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2309 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2310 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2311 }
2312}
2313
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002314/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2315/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002316QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002317 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2318 // structure.
2319 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2320 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002321
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002322 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002323 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2324 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002325
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002326 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2327 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2328 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002329 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002330 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002331
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002332 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2333 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002334 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002335 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002336 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002337 Types.push_back(New);
2338 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2339 return QualType(New, 0);
2340}
2341
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002342/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2343/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002344QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002345 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2346 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002347 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002348 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002349
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002350 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002351 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002352 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002353
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002354 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2355 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002356 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002357 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002358 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002359
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002360 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2361 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002362 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002363 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002364 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002365 Types.push_back(New);
2366 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002367 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002368}
2369
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002370QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2371 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2372 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002373 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002374 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2375 if (AT)
2376 return QualType(AT, 0);
2377
2378 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2379
2380 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2381 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002382 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002383
2384 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2385 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2386 Types.push_back(AT);
2387 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2388 return QualType(AT, 0);
2389}
2390
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002391QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2392 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2393
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002394 QualType Decayed;
2395
2396 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2397 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2398 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2399 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2400 // the array type derivation.
2401 if (T->isArrayType())
2402 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2403
2404 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2405 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2406 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2407 // in 6.3.2.1.
2408 if (T->isFunctionType())
2409 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2410
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002411 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2412 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002413 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002414 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2415 if (AT)
2416 return QualType(AT, 0);
2417
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002418 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2419
2420 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002421 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002422 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002423
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002424 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2425 Types.push_back(AT);
2426 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2427 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002428}
2429
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002430/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002431/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002432QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002433 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2434 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002435 // structure.
2436 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2437 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002438
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002439 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002440 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2441 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2442 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002443
2444 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002445 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2446 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002447 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002448 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002449
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002450 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2451 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2452 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002453 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002454 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002455 BlockPointerType *New
2456 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002457 Types.push_back(New);
2458 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2459 return QualType(New, 0);
2460}
2461
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002462/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2463/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002464QualType
2465ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002466 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2467 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2468
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002469 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2470 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002471 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002472 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002473
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002474 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002475 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2476 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002477 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002478
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002479 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2480
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002481 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2482 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2483 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002484 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2485 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2486 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002487
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002488 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002489 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2490 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002491 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002492 }
2493
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002494 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002495 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2496 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002497 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002498 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002499
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002500 return QualType(New, 0);
2501}
2502
2503/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2504/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002505QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002506 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2507 // structure.
2508 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002509 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002510
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002511 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002512 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2513 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2514 return QualType(RT, 0);
2515
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002516 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2517
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002518 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2519 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2520 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002521 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2522 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2523 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002524
2525 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2526 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2527 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002528 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002529 }
2530
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002531 RValueReferenceType *New
2532 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002533 Types.push_back(New);
2534 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002535 return QualType(New, 0);
2536}
2537
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002538/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2539/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002540QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002541 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2542 // structure.
2543 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2544 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2545
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002546 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002547 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2548 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2549 return QualType(PT, 0);
2550
2551 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2552 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2553 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002554 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002555 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2556
2557 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2558 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2559 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002560 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002561 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002562 MemberPointerType *New
2563 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002564 Types.push_back(New);
2565 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2566 return QualType(New, 0);
2567}
2568
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002569/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002570/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002571QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002572 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002573 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002574 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002575 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2576 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002577 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2578
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002579 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2580 // the target.
2581 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002582 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002583 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002584
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002585 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002586 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002587
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002588 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002589 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002590 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002591 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002592
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002593 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2594 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2595 QualType Canon;
2596 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2597 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002598 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002599 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002600 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002601
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002602 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002603 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002604 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002605 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002606 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002607
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002608 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002609 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002610 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002611 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002612 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002613}
2614
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002615/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2616/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2617/// sizes replaced with [*].
2618QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2619 // Vastly most common case.
2620 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002621
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002622 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002623
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002624 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002625 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002626 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2627#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2628#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2629#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2630#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2631 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2632
2633 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2634 case Type::Builtin:
2635 case Type::Complex:
2636 case Type::Vector:
2637 case Type::ExtVector:
2638 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2639 case Type::ObjCObject:
2640 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2641 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2642 case Type::Record:
2643 case Type::Enum:
2644 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2645 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2646 case Type::TypeOf:
2647 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002648 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002649 case Type::DependentName:
2650 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2651 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2652 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2653 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2654 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002655 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002656 case Type::PackExpansion:
2657 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2658
2659 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2660 // further decay.
2661 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2662 case Type::FunctionProto:
2663 case Type::BlockPointer:
2664 case Type::MemberPointer:
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00002665 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002666 return type;
2667
2668 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2669 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2670 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2671 // optimizations available here.
2672 case Type::Pointer:
2673 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2674 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2675 break;
2676
2677 case Type::LValueReference: {
2678 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2679 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2680 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2681 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2682 break;
2683 }
2684
2685 case Type::RValueReference: {
2686 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2687 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2688 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2689 break;
2690 }
2691
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002692 case Type::Atomic: {
2693 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2694 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2695 break;
2696 }
2697
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002698 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2699 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2700 result = getConstantArrayType(
2701 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2702 cat->getSize(),
2703 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2704 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2705 break;
2706 }
2707
2708 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2709 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2710 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2711 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2712 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2713 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2714 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2715 dat->getBracketsRange());
2716 break;
2717 }
2718
2719 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2720 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2721 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2722 result = getVariableArrayType(
2723 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002724 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002725 ArrayType::Normal,
2726 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2727 SourceRange());
2728 break;
2729 }
2730
2731 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2732 case Type::VariableArray: {
2733 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2734 result = getVariableArrayType(
2735 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002736 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002737 ArrayType::Star,
2738 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2739 vat->getBracketsRange());
2740 break;
2741 }
2742 }
2743
2744 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002745 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002746}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002747
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002748/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2749/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002750QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2751 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002752 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002753 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002754 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002755 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2756 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002757 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002758
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002759 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2760 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2761 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002762 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002763 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002764 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002765 }
2766
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002767 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002768 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002769
2770 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2771 Types.push_back(New);
2772 return QualType(New, 0);
2773}
2774
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002775/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2776/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002777/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002778QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2779 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002780 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002781 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2782 SourceRange brackets) const {
2783 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2784 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002785 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2786
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002787 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2788 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2789 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2790 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2791 if (!numElements) {
2792 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2793 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2794 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2795 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2796 brackets);
2797 Types.push_back(newType);
2798 return QualType(newType, 0);
2799 }
2800
2801 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2802 // also build a canonical type.
2803
2804 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2805
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002806 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002807 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002808 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002809 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002810 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002811
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002812 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2813 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2814 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002815
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002816 // If we don't have one, build one.
2817 if (!canonTy) {
2818 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002819 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002820 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2821 brackets);
2822 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2823 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002824 }
2825
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002826 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2827 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002828 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002829
David Majnemer16a74702015-07-24 05:54:19 +00002830 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size
2831 // expression, then just use that as our result.
2832 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType &&
2833 canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002834 return canon;
2835
2836 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2837 // of the element type.
2838 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2839 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2840 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2841 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2842 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2843 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002844}
2845
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002846QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002847 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002848 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002849 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002850 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002851
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002852 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002853 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2854 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2855 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002856
2857 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002858 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2859 // qualifiers off the element type.
2860 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002861
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002862 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2863 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002864 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002865 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002866 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002867
2868 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002869 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2870 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2871 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002872 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002873
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002874 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2875 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002876
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002877 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2878 Types.push_back(newType);
2879 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002880}
2881
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002882/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2883/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002884QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002885 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002886 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002887
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002888 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2889 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002890 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002891
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002892 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002893 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2894 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2895
2896 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2897 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2898 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002899 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002900 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002901
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002902 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2903 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002904 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002905 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002906 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002907 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002908 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2909 Types.push_back(New);
2910 return QualType(New, 0);
2911}
2912
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002913/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002914/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002915QualType
2916ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002917 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002918
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002919 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2920 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002921 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002922 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002923 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002924 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2925 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2926
2927 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2928 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2929 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002930 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002931 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002932
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002933 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2934 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002935 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002936 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002937 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2938 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002939 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2940 Types.push_back(New);
2941 return QualType(New, 0);
2942}
2943
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002944QualType
2945ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2946 Expr *SizeExpr,
2947 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002948 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002949 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002950 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002951
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002952 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002953 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2954 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2955 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2956 if (Canon) {
2957 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2958 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002959 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2960 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2961 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002962 } else {
2963 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2964 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002965 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2966 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2967 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002968
2969 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2970 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2971 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2972 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002973 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2974 } else {
2975 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2976 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002977 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2978 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002979 }
2980 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002981
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002982 Types.push_back(New);
2983 return QualType(New, 0);
2984}
2985
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00002986/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2987static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2988 return T.isCanonical() &&
2989 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2990 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2991}
2992
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002993/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002994///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002995QualType
2996ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2997 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002998 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2999 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00003000 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00003001 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003002
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003003 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003004 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003005 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003006 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003007
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003008 QualType Canonical;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003009 if (!isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy)) {
3010 Canonical =
3011 getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003012
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003013 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003014 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
3015 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003016 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003017 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003018
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003019 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003020 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, Info);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003021 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003022 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003023 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003024}
3025
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003026CanQualType
3027ASTContext::getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const {
3028 CanQualType CanResultType = getCanonicalType(ResultType);
3029
3030 // Canonical result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
3031 if (CanResultType.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
3032 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultType.getQualifiers();
3033 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
3034 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(
3035 getQualifiedType(CanResultType.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs));
3036 }
3037
3038 return CanResultType;
3039}
3040
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003041QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003042ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003043 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003044 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
3045
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003046 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3047 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00003048 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003049 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
3050 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003051
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003052 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003053 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003054 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003055 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003056
3057 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003058 bool isCanonical =
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003059 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003060 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003061 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003062 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003063 isCanonical = false;
3064
3065 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003066 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003067 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00003068 if (!isCanonical) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003069 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003070 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3071 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003072 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003073
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003074 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003075 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003076 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003077
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003078 // Adjust the canonical function result type.
3079 CanQualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy);
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003080 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003081
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003082 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003083 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
3084 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003085 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003086 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003087
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003088 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
3089 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
3090 // - parameter types
3091 // - exception types
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003092 // - extended parameter information
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003093 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003094 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
3095 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003096 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003097 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003098
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003099 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3100 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3101 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00003102 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003103 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00003104 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003105 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003106 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003107 }
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003108
3109 // Put the ExtParameterInfos last. If all were equal, it would make
3110 // more sense to put these before the exception specification, because
3111 // it's much easier to skip past them compared to the elaborate switch
3112 // required to skip the exception specification. However, all is not
3113 // equal; ExtParameterInfos are used to model very uncommon features,
3114 // and it's better not to burden the more common paths.
3115 if (EPI.ExtParameterInfos) {
3116 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo);
3117 }
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003118
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003119 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00003120 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003121 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003122 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003123 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003124 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003125}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00003126
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003127/// Return pipe type for the specified type.
3128QualType ASTContext::getPipeType(QualType T) const {
3129 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3130 PipeType::Profile(ID, T);
3131
3132 void *InsertPos = 0;
3133 if (PipeType *PT = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3134 return QualType(PT, 0);
3135
3136 // If the pipe element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3137 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3138 QualType Canonical;
3139 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3140 Canonical = getPipeType(getCanonicalType(T));
3141
3142 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3143 PipeType *NewIP = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3144 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3145 (void)NewIP;
3146 }
3147 PipeType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PipeType(T, Canonical);
3148 Types.push_back(New);
3149 PipeTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3150 return QualType(New, 0);
3151}
3152
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003153#ifndef NDEBUG
3154static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3155 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3156 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3157 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3158 return true;
3159 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3160 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3161 return true;
3162 return false;
3163}
3164#endif
3165
3166/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3167/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
3168QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003169 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003170 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3171 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3172 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003173 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003174 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3175 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3176 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3177 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003178 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003179 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003180 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3181 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003182 }
3183 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3184}
3185
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003186/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3187/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003188QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00003189 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003190 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003191
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003192 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003193 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003194
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003195 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3196 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3197
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003198 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003199 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003200 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003201 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003202 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003203 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003204 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003205 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00003206 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003207 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3208 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3209 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00003210 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003211 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003212
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003213 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003214}
3215
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00003216/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003217/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003218QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003219ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3220 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003221 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003222
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003223 if (Canonical.isNull())
3224 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003225 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003226 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003227 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3228 Types.push_back(newType);
3229 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00003230}
3231
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003232QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003233 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3234
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003235 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003236 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3237 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3238
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003239 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3240 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3241 Types.push_back(newType);
3242 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003243}
3244
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003245QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003246 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3247
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003248 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003249 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3250 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3251
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003252 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3253 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3254 Types.push_back(newType);
3255 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003256}
3257
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003258QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3259 QualType modifiedType,
3260 QualType equivalentType) {
3261 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3262 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3263
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003264 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003265 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3266 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3267
3268 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3269 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3270 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3271
3272 Types.push_back(type);
3273 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3274
3275 return QualType(type, 0);
3276}
3277
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003278/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3279QualType
3280ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003281 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003282 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003283 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3284
3285 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3286 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003287 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003288 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3289 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3290
3291 if (!SubstParm) {
3292 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3293 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3294 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3295 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3296 }
3297
3298 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3299}
3300
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003301/// \brief Retrieve a
3302QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3303 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3304 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3305#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003306 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3307 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3308 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003309 }
3310#endif
3311
3312 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3313 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003314 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003315 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3316 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3317 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3318
3319 QualType Canon;
3320 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3321 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3322 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3323 ArgPack);
3324 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3325 }
3326
3327 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3328 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3329 ArgPack);
3330 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3331 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3332 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3333}
3334
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003335/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003336/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003337/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003338QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003339 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003340 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003341 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003342 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003343 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003344 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003345 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3346
3347 if (TypeParm)
3348 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003349
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003350 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003351 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003352 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003353
3354 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3355 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3356 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3357 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003358 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003359 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3360 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003361
3362 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3363 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3364
3365 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3366}
3367
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003368TypeSourceInfo *
3369ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3370 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3371 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003372 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003373 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3374 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003375 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003376
3377 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003378 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3379 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003380 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003381 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3382 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3383 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3384 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3385 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3386 return DI;
3387}
3388
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003389QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003390ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003391 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003392 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003393 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3394 "No dependent template names here!");
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003395
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003396 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003397 ArgVec.reserve(Args.size());
3398 for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg : Args.arguments())
3399 ArgVec.push_back(Arg.getArgument());
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003400
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003401 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec, Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003402}
3403
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003404#ifndef NDEBUG
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003405static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) {
3406 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3407 if (Arg.isPackExpansion())
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003408 return true;
3409
3410 return true;
3411}
3412#endif
3413
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003414QualType
3415ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003416 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003417 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003418 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3419 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003420 // Look through qualified template names.
3421 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3422 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003423
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003424 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003425 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3426 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003427 QualType CanonType;
3428 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3429 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3430 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003431 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3432 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003433 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args)) &&
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003434 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3435 IsTypeAlias = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003436 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args);
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003437 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003438
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003439 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3440 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3441 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003442 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003443 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * Args.size() +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003444 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003445 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003446 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003447 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, CanonType,
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003448 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003449
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003450 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003451 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003452}
3453
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003454QualType ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(
3455 TemplateName Template, ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003456 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3457 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003458
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003459 // Look through qualified template names.
3460 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3461 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003462
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003463 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3464 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003465 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003466 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003467 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003468 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3469 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Arg));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003470
3471 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3472 // exists.
3473 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3474 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003475 CanonArgs, *this);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003476
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003477 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003478 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3479 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3480
3481 if (!Spec) {
3482 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3483 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3484 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3485 TypeAlignment);
3486 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003487 CanonArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003488 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003489 Types.push_back(Spec);
3490 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3491 }
3492
3493 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3494 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3495 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3496}
3497
3498QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003499ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3500 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003501 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003502 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003503 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003504
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003505 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003506 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003507 if (T)
3508 return QualType(T, 0);
3509
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003510 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3511 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3512 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003513 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3514 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003515 (void)CheckT;
3516 }
3517
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003518 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003519 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003520 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003521 return QualType(T, 0);
3522}
3523
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003524QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003525ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003526 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3527 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3528
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003529 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003530 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3531 if (T)
3532 return QualType(T, 0);
3533
3534 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3535 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3536 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3537 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3538 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3539 (void)CheckT;
3540 }
3541
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003542 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003543 Types.push_back(T);
3544 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3545 return QualType(T, 0);
3546}
3547
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003548QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3549 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3550 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003551 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003552 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3553 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003554 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3555 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3556 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3557
3558 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3559 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003560 }
3561
3562 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003563 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003564
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003565 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003566 DependentNameType *T
3567 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003568 if (T)
3569 return QualType(T, 0);
3570
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003571 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003572 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003573 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003574 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003575}
3576
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003577QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003578ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3579 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003580 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003581 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003582 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003583 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003584 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003585 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3586 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003587 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name, ArgCopy);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003588}
3589
3590QualType
3591ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3592 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3593 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3594 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003595 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003596 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3597 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003598
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003599 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003600 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003601 Name, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003602
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003603 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003604 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3605 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003606 if (T)
3607 return QualType(T, 0);
3608
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003609 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003610
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003611 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3612 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3613
3614 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003615 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003616 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003617 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3618 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3619 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3620 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003621 }
3622
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003623 QualType Canon;
3624 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3625 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003626 Name,
3627 CanonArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003628
3629 // Find the insert position again.
3630 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3631 }
3632
3633 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3634 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3635 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003636 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003637 Name, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003638 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003639 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003640 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003641}
3642
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003643QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003644 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003645 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003646 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003647
3648 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3649 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003650 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003651 PackExpansionType *T
3652 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3653 if (T)
3654 return QualType(T, 0);
3655
3656 QualType Canon;
3657 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003658 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3659 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3660 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3661 // parameters.
3662 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003663 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003664
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003665 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3666 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3667 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3668 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003669 }
3670
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003671 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3672 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003673 Types.push_back(T);
3674 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003675 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003676}
3677
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003678/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3679/// alphabetically.
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003680static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
3681 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
3682 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003683}
3684
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00003685static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols) {
3686 if (Protocols.empty()) return true;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003687
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003688 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3689 return false;
3690
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00003691 for (unsigned i = 1; i != Protocols.size(); ++i)
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003692 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003693 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003694 return false;
3695 return true;
3696}
3697
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003698static void
3699SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &Protocols) {
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003700 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003701 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end(), CmpProtocolNames);
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003702
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003703 // Canonicalize.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003704 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *&P : Protocols)
3705 P = P->getCanonicalDecl();
3706
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003707 // Remove duplicates.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003708 auto ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end());
3709 Protocols.erase(ProtocolsEnd, Protocols.end());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003710}
3711
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003712QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3713 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003714 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003715 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, { },
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003716 llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
3717 /*isKindOf=*/false);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003718}
3719
3720QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
3721 QualType baseType,
3722 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003723 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
3724 bool isKindOf) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003725 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
3726 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003727 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
3728 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003729 return baseType;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003730
3731 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003732 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003733 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003734 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003735 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3736 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003737
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003738 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
3739 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
3740 // type.
3741 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
3742 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
3743 if (auto baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
3744 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
3745 }
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003746
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003747 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
3748 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
3749 // canonicalized.
3750 QualType canonical;
3751 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(),
3752 effectiveTypeArgs.end(),
3753 [&](QualType type) {
3754 return type.isCanonical();
3755 });
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00003756 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003757 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
3758 // Determine the canonical type arguments.
3759 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
3760 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
3761 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
3762 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
3763 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
3764 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
3765 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003766 } else {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003767 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003768 }
3769
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003770 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
3771 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
3772 if (!protocolsSorted) {
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003773 canonProtocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
3774 SortAndUniqueProtocols(canonProtocolsVec);
3775 canonProtocols = canonProtocolsVec;
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003776 } else {
3777 canonProtocols = protocols;
3778 }
3779
3780 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003781 canonProtocols, isKindOf);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003782
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003783 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003784 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3785 }
3786
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003787 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3788 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3789 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3790 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003791 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003792 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
3793 isKindOf);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003794
3795 Types.push_back(T);
3796 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3797 return QualType(T, 0);
3798}
3799
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003800/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3801/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3802/// list.
3803bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3804 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3805 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3806 return false;
3807
3808 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3809 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003810 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003811 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3812 return false;
3813 }
3814 return true;
3815 }
3816 return false;
3817}
3818
3819/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3820/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3821/// of protocols.
3822bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3823 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3824 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3825 return false;
3826 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3827 if (!OPT)
3828 return false;
3829 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3830 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003831 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3832 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3833 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3834 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003835 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3836 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3837 bool Conforms = false;
3838 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3839 Conforms = false;
3840 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3841 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3842 Conforms = true;
3843 break;
3844 }
3845 }
3846 if (!Conforms)
3847 break;
3848 }
3849 if (Conforms)
3850 return true;
3851
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003852 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003853 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3854 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003855 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003856 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003857 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003858 break;
3859 }
3860 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003861 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003862 }
3863 return true;
3864}
3865
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003866/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3867/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003868QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003869 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3870 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3871
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003872 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003873 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3874 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3875 return QualType(QT, 0);
3876
3877 // Find the canonical object type.
3878 QualType Canonical;
3879 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3880 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3881
3882 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003883 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3884 }
3885
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003886 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003887 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3888 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3889 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003890
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003891 Types.push_back(QType);
3892 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003893 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003894}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003895
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003896/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3897/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003898QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3899 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003900 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3901 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003902
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003903 if (PrevDecl) {
3904 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3905 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3906 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3907 }
3908
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003909 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3910 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3911 Decl = Def;
3912
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003913 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3914 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3915 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3916 Types.push_back(T);
3917 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003918}
3919
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003920/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3921/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003922/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003923/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003924/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003925QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003926 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003927 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3928 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3929 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003930
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003931 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003932 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3933 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3934 if (Canon) {
3935 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3936 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003937 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003938 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003939 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003940 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003941 Canon
3942 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003943 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3944 toe = Canon;
3945 }
3946 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003947 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003948 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003949 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003950 Types.push_back(toe);
3951 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003952}
3953
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003954/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003955/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003956/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003957/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3958/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003959QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003960 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003961 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003962 Types.push_back(tot);
3963 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003964}
3965
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003966/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3967/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3968/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3969/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003970QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003971 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003972
3973 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003974 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003975 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3976 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003977 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003978 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3979 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003980
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003981 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003982 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3983 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003984 if (!Canon) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003985 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003986 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003987 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003988 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003989 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3990 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003991 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003992 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3993 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003994 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003995 Types.push_back(dt);
3996 return QualType(dt, 0);
3997}
3998
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003999/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
4000/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
4001QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
4002 QualType UnderlyingType,
4003 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
4004 const {
Vassil Vassilevbab6f962016-03-30 22:18:29 +00004005 UnaryTransformType *ut = nullptr;
4006
4007 if (BaseType->isDependentType()) {
4008 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4009 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4010 DependentUnaryTransformType::Profile(ID, getCanonicalType(BaseType), Kind);
4011
4012 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4013 DependentUnaryTransformType *Canon
4014 = DependentUnaryTransformTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4015
4016 if (!Canon) {
4017 // Build a new, canonical __underlying_type(type) type.
4018 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4019 DependentUnaryTransformType(*this, getCanonicalType(BaseType),
4020 Kind);
4021 DependentUnaryTransformTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4022 }
4023 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4024 QualType(), Kind,
4025 QualType(Canon, 0));
4026 } else {
4027 QualType CanonType = getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType);
4028 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4029 UnderlyingType, Kind,
4030 CanonType);
4031 }
4032 Types.push_back(ut);
4033 return QualType(ut, 0);
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004034}
4035
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004036/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
4037/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
4038/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004039QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004040 bool IsDependent) const {
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004041 if (DeducedType.isNull() && Keyword == AutoTypeKeyword::Auto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004042 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004043
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004044 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004045 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004046 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004047 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004048 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4049 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004050
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00004051 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004052 Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004053 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004054 Types.push_back(AT);
4055 if (InsertPos)
4056 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
4057 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00004058}
4059
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004060/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
4061/// the given value type.
4062QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
4063 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
4064 // structure.
4065 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4066 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
4067
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004068 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004069 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4070 return QualType(AT, 0);
4071
4072 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
4073 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
4074 QualType Canonical;
4075 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
4076 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
4077
4078 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4079 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004080 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004081 }
4082 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
4083 Types.push_back(New);
4084 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4085 return QualType(New, 0);
4086}
4087
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004088/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
4089QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
4090 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004091 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004092 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::Auto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004093 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004094 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004095 return AutoDeductTy;
4096}
4097
4098/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
4099QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
4100 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
4101 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
4102 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
4103 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
4104}
4105
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004106/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4107/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004108QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00004109 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00004110 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
4111 // away const? mutable?
4112 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004113}
4114
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004115/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
4116/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
4117/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00004118CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004119 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00004120}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004121
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004122/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4123CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
4124 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
4125}
4126
4127/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4128CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
4129 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
4130}
4131
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00004132/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
4133/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4134QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
4135 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4136 return WCharTy;
4137}
4138
4139/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
4140/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4141QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
4142 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4143 return UnsignedIntTy;
4144}
4145
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00004146QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
4147 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
4148}
4149
4150QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
4151 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
4152}
4153
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004154/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004155/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
4156QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004157 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004158}
4159
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00004160/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
4161/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
4162QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
4163 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
4164}
4165
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004166//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4167// Type Operators
4168//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4169
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004170CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004171 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
4172 // qualifiers.
4173 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00004174 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004175 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004176 QualType Result;
4177 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
4178 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
4179 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
4180 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
4181 } else {
4182 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
4183 }
4184
4185 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
4186}
4187
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004188QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
4189 Qualifiers &quals) {
4190 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
4191
4192 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
4193 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
4194 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
4195 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
4196 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004197 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004198
4199 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004200 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004201 quals = splitType.Quals;
4202 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004203 }
4204
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004205 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4206 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4207 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4208
4209 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4210 // can just use the results in splitType.
4211 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4212 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004213 quals = splitType.Quals;
4214 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004215 }
4216
4217 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4218 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004219 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004220
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004221 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004222 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004223 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4224 }
4225
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004226 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004227 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004228 }
4229
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004230 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004231 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004232 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004233 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4234 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4235 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4236 }
4237
4238 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004239 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004240 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4241 SourceRange());
4242}
4243
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004244/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
4245/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4246/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4247/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4248/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4249/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4250/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4251/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4252bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4253 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4254 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4255 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4256 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4257 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4258 return true;
4259 }
4260
4261 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4262 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4263 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4264 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4265 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4266 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4267 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4268 return true;
4269 }
4270
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004271 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004272 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4273 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4274 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4275 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4276 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4277 return true;
4278 }
4279 }
4280
4281 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4282
4283 return false;
4284}
4285
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004286DeclarationNameInfo
4287ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4288 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004289 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4290 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4291 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004292 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004293 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4294 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004295
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004296 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4297 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4298 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4299 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4300 }
4301
4302 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4303 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004304 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004305 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004306 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4307 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004308 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004309 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4310 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4311 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4312 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4313 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4314 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004315 }
4316 }
4317
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004318 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4319 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4320 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4321 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4322 NameLoc);
4323 }
4324
4325 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4326 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4327 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4328 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4329 NameLoc);
4330 }
4331 }
4332
4333 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004334}
4335
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004336TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004337 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4338 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4339 case TemplateName::Template: {
4340 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004341 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004342 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004343 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4344
4345 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004346 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004347 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004348
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004349 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4350 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004351
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004352 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4353 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4354 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4355 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4356 }
4357
4358 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4359 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4360 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4361 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4362 }
4363
4364 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4365 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4366 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4367 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4368 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4369 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4370 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4371 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4372 }
4373 }
4374
4375 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004376}
4377
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004378bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4379 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4380 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4381 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4382}
4383
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004384TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004385ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004386 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4387 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4388 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004389
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004390 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004391 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004392
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004393 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004394 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
David Blaikie952a9b12014-10-17 18:00:12 +00004395 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004396 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004397
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004398 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4399 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4400 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4401
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004402 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4403 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004404
4405 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4406 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4407 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004408 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004409
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004410 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004411 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004412
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004413 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004414 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004415
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004416 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004417 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4418 return Arg;
4419
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004420 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4421 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004422 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004423 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004424 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4425 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4426 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004427
Benjamin Kramercce63472015-08-05 09:40:22 +00004428 return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size()));
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004429 }
4430 }
4431
4432 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004433 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004434}
4435
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004436NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004437ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004438 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004439 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004440
4441 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4442 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4443 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004444 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004445 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4446 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4447
4448 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4449 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4450 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004451 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004452 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4453
4454 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4455 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4456 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004457 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004458 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4459 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004460
4461 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4462 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4463 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004464
4465 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4466 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4467 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4468 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4469 // types, e.g.,
4470 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4471 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004472 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4473 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004474 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004475
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004476 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4477 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4478 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004479 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4480 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004481 }
4482
4483 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
Nikola Smiljanic67860242014-09-26 00:28:20 +00004484 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
4485 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004486 return NNS;
4487 }
4488
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004489 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004490}
4491
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004492const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004493 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004494 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004495 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4496 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4497 return AT;
4498 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004499
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004500 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004501 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004502 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004503
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004504 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004505 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4506 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004507
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004508 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4509 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004510 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004511
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004512 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004513 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004514
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004515 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004516 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004517 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004518 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004519
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004520 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4521 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004522 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004523
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004524 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4525 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4526 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004527 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004528 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4529 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4530 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004531 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004532
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004533 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004534 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4535 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004536 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004537 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004538 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004539 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004540 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004541
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004542 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004543 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004544 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004545 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004546 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004547 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004548}
4549
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004550QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004551 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4552 return getDecayedType(T);
4553 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004554}
4555
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004556QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004557 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4558 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4559 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4560}
4561
David Majnemerd09a51c2015-03-03 01:50:05 +00004562QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
4563 // C++ [except.throw]p3:
4564 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
4565 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
4566 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
4567 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
4568 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
4569 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4570 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4571 T = getDecayedType(T);
4572 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4573}
4574
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004575/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4576/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4577/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4578/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4579///
4580/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004581QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004582 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4583 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4584 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4585 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4586 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4587 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004588
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004589 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004590
4591 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004592 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004593}
4594
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004595QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4596 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004597}
4598
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004599QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4600 Qualifiers qs;
4601 while (true) {
4602 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004603 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004604 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004605
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004606 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004607 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004608 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004609
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004610 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004611}
4612
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004613/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004614uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004615ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4616 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4617 do {
4618 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004619 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4620 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004621 } while (CA);
4622 return ElementCount;
4623}
4624
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004625/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4626/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004627static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004628 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004629 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004630
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004631 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4632 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004633 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004634 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004635 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4636 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4637 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00004638 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Float128Rank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004639 }
4640}
4641
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004642/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4643/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004644/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4645/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004646QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4647 QualType Domain) const {
4648 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4649 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4650 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004651 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004652 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4653 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4654 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00004655 case Float128Rank: return Float128ComplexTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004656 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004657 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004658
4659 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4660 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004661 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004662 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4663 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4664 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00004665 case Float128Rank: return Float128Ty;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004666 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004667 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004668}
4669
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004670/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4671/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4672/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004673/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004674int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004675 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4676 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004677
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004678 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004679 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004680 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004681 return 1;
4682 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004683}
4684
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004685/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4686/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4687/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004688unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004689 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004690
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004691 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004692 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004693 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004694 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004695 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4696 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4697 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4698 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004699 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004700 case BuiltinType::Short:
4701 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004702 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004703 case BuiltinType::Int:
4704 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004705 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004706 case BuiltinType::Long:
4707 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004708 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004709 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4710 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004711 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004712 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4713 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4714 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004715 }
4716}
4717
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004718/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4719/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4720///
4721/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4722/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004723QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004724 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4725 return QualType();
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004726
4727 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
4728 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
4729 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
4730
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004731 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004732 if (!Field)
4733 return QualType();
4734
4735 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4736
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004737 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004738 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004739 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
4740 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
4741 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
4742 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
4743 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
4744 // promotion applies to it.
4745 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
4746 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
4747 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
4748 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
4749 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
4750 //
4751 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
4752 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004753 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4754 return IntTy;
4755
4756 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4757 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4758
4759 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004760 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
4761 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
4762 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
4763 // into their semantics in some cases).
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004764 return QualType();
4765}
4766
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004767/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4768/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4769/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004770QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004771 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4772 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004773 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4774 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004775
4776 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4777 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4778 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4779 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4780 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4781 // unsigned long long int [...]
4782 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4783 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4784 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4785 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4786 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4787 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4788 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4789 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4790 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4791 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4792 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4793 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4794 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4795 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4796 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4797 }
4798 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4799 }
4800 }
4801
4802 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004803 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4804 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004805 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4806 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004807 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4808 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4809}
4810
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004811/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4812/// type and returns its ownership.
4813Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4814 while (!T.isNull()) {
4815 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4816 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4817 if (T->isArrayType())
4818 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4819 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4820 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4821 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004822 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004823 else
4824 break;
4825 }
4826
4827 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4828}
4829
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004830static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4831 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4832 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4833 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4834 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004835 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004836}
4837
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004838/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004839/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004840/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004841int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004842 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4843 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004844
4845 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4846 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4847 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4848 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4849 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4850
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004851 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004852
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004853 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4854 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004855
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004856 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4857 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004858
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004859 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4860 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4861 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4862 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004863
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004864 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4865 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4866 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4867 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4868 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004869
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004870 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4871 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004872 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004873 return -1;
4874 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004875
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004876 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4877 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4878 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004879
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004880 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4881 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004882 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004883 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004884}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004885
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004886TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringDecl() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004887 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004888 assert(!CFConstantStringTagDecl &&
4889 "tag and typedef should be initialized together");
4890 CFConstantStringTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__NSConstantString_tag");
4891 CFConstantStringTagDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004892
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004893 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004894 const char *FieldNames[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004895
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004896 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004897 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004898 FieldNames[0] = "isa";
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004899 // int flags;
4900 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004901 FieldNames[1] = "flags";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004902 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004903 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004904 FieldNames[2] = "str";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004905 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004906 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004907 FieldNames[3] = "length";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004908
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004909 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004910 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004911 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTagDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004912 SourceLocation(),
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00004913 SourceLocation(),
4914 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004915 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4916 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004917 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004918 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004919 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004920 CFConstantStringTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004921 }
4922
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004923 CFConstantStringTagDecl->completeDefinition();
4924 // This type is designed to be compatible with NSConstantString, but cannot
4925 // use the same name, since NSConstantString is an interface.
4926 auto tagType = getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTagDecl);
4927 CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
4928 buildImplicitTypedef(tagType, "__NSConstantString");
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004929 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004930
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00004931 return CFConstantStringTypeDecl;
4932}
4933
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004934RecordDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringTagDecl() const {
4935 if (!CFConstantStringTagDecl)
4936 getCFConstantStringDecl(); // Build the tag and the typedef.
4937 return CFConstantStringTagDecl;
4938}
4939
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00004940// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
4941QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004942 return getTypedefType(getCFConstantStringDecl());
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004943}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004944
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004945QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4946 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004947 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004948 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4949 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4950 }
4951 return ObjCSuperType;
4952}
4953
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004954void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00004955 const TypedefType *TD = T->getAs<TypedefType>();
4956 assert(TD && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4957 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = cast<TypedefDecl>(TD->getDecl());
4958 auto TagType =
4959 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<RecordType>();
4960 assert(TagType && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4961 CFConstantStringTagDecl = TagType->getDecl();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004962}
4963
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004964QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004965 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4966 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4967
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004968 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004969 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004970 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4971 RD->startDefinition();
4972
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004973 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4974 UnsignedLongTy,
4975 UnsignedLongTy,
4976 };
4977
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004978 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004979 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004980 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004981 };
4982
4983 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004984 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4985 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004986 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4987 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004988 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004989 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004990 }
4991
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004992 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004993
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004994 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004995
4996 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4997}
4998
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004999QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005000 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
5001 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5002
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005003 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005004 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005005 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
5006 RD->startDefinition();
5007
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005008 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5009 UnsignedLongTy,
5010 UnsignedLongTy,
5011 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
5012 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
5013 };
5014
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005015 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005016 "reserved",
5017 "Size",
5018 "CopyFuncPtr",
5019 "DestroyFuncPtr"
5020 };
5021
5022 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005023 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5024 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005025 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5026 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005027 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005028 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005029 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005030 }
5031
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005032 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005033
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005034 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005035 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5036}
5037
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005038/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
5039/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
5040/// in buildByrefHelpers.
5041bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
5042 const VarDecl *D) {
5043 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
5044 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
5045 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
5046
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005047 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00005048 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005049
5050 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
5051
5052 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
5053
5054 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
5055 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005056 switch (lifetime) {
5057 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
5058
5059 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
5060 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
5061 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
5062 return false;
5063
5064 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
5065 // byref routines.
5066 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
5067 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
5068 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
5069 return true;
5070 }
5071 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
5072 }
5073 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
5074 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005075}
5076
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005077bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
5078 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
5079 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
5080
5081 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
5082 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
5083 return false;
5084
5085 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00005086 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005087 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
5088 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005089 } else if ((LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime())) {
5090 // Honor the ARC qualifiers.
5091 } else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
5092 // The MRR rule.
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005093 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005094 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005095 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005096 }
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005097 return true;
5098}
5099
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005100TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
5101 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005102 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
5103 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005104 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
5105}
5106
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005107// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
5108// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00005109static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005110 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00005111 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
5112 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005113
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005114 return false;
5115}
5116
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005117/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005118/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005119CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005120 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
5121 return CharUnits::Zero();
5122
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005123 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005124
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005125 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00005126 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005127 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005128 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
5129 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005130 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005131 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005132}
5133
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005134bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00005135 return getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
5136 VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
David Majnemerfac52432015-10-19 23:22:49 +00005137 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5138 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005139}
5140
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005141ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind
5142ASTContext::getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(const VarDecl *VD) const {
5143 if (!VD->isInline())
5144 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None;
5145
5146 // In almost all cases, it's a weak definition.
5147 auto *First = VD->getFirstDecl();
5148 if (!First->isConstexpr() || First->isInlineSpecified() ||
5149 !VD->isStaticDataMember())
5150 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak;
5151
5152 // If there's a file-context declaration in this translation unit, it's a
5153 // non-discardable definition.
5154 for (auto *D : VD->redecls())
5155 if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFileContext())
5156 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong;
5157
5158 // If we've not seen one yet, we don't know.
5159 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown;
5160}
5161
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005162static inline
5163std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
5164 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005165}
5166
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005167/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005168/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005169std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
5170 std::string S;
5171
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005172 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
5173 QualType BlockTy =
5174 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5175 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005176 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005177 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
5178 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
5179 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005180 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005181 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005182 // Compute size of all parameters.
5183 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5184 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5185 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005186 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5187 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005188 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00005189 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005190 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00005191 if (sz.isZero())
5192 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005193 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005194 ParmOffset += sz;
5195 }
5196 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005197 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005198 // Block pointer and offset.
5199 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005200
5201 // Argument types.
5202 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005203 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005204 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5205 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5206 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5207 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5208 // elements.
5209 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5210 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5211 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5212 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005213 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005214 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
5215 S, true /*Extended*/);
5216 else
5217 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005218 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005219 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005220 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005221
5222 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005223}
5224
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005225bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005226 std::string& S) {
5227 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005228 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005229 CharUnits ParmOffset;
5230 // Compute size of all parameters.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005231 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005232 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005233 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005234 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005235 continue;
5236
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005237 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005238 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005239 ParmOffset += sz;
5240 }
5241 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5242 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
5243
5244 // Argument types.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005245 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005246 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5247 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5248 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5249 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5250 // elements.
5251 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5252 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5253 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5254 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5255 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5256 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5257 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5258 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005259
5260 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005261}
5262
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005263/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5264/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5265/// block object types.
5266void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5267 QualType T, std::string& S,
5268 bool Extended) const {
5269 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5270 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5271 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005272 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005273 true /*OutermostType*/,
5274 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
5275 false /*StructField*/,
5276 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
5277 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
5278}
5279
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005280/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005281/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005282bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005283 std::string& S,
5284 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005285 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005286 // Encode return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005287 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5288 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005289 // Compute size of all parameters.
5290 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5291 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5292 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005293 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005294 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
5295 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005296 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005297 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005298 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00005299 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005300 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005301 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005302 continue;
5303
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005304 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5305 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005306 ParmOffset += sz;
5307 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005308 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005309 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005310 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005311
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005312 // Argument types.
5313 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005314 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005315 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005316 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005317 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00005318 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005319 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5320 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5321 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00005322 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005323 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5324 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5325 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005326 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5327 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005328 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005329 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005330 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005331
5332 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005333}
5334
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005335ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
5336ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
5337 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5338 const Decl *Container) const {
5339 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005340 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005341 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
5342 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00005343 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
5344 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5345 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005346 } else {
5347 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
5348 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
5349 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5350 return PID;
5351 }
5352 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005353}
5354
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005355/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005356/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005357/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
5358/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005359/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
5360/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
5361/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
5362/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
5363/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005364/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
5365/// @code
5366/// enum PropertyAttributes {
5367/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
5368/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5369/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5370/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
5371/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
5372/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
5373/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00005374/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005375/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5376/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5377/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5378/// };
5379/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005380void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005381 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005382 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005383 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5384 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005385 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005386
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005387 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5388 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5389 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5390 Dynamic = true;
5391 else
5392 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005393 }
5394
5395 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5396 S = "T";
5397
5398 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005399 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5400 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005401 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005402
5403 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5404 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005405 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5406 S += ",C";
5407 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5408 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00005409 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5410 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005411 } else {
5412 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5413 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5414 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005415 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005416 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005417 }
5418 }
5419
5420 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5421 // are "dynamic by default".
5422 if (Dynamic)
5423 S += ",D";
5424
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005425 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5426 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005427
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005428 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5429 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005430 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005431 }
5432
5433 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5434 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005435 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005436 }
5437
5438 if (SynthesizePID) {
5439 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5440 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005441 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005442 }
5443
5444 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5445}
5446
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005447/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005448/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5449/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005450/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5451///
5452void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005453 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005454 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005455 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005456 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005457 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005458 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005459 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5460 }
5461 }
5462}
5463
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005464void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005465 const FieldDecl *Field,
5466 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005467 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5468 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5469 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5470 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005471 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005472 true /* outermost type */, false, false,
5473 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005474}
5475
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005476void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5477 std::string& S) const {
5478 // Encode result type.
5479 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5480 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5481 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5482 true /* outermost type */,
5483 true /* encoding property */);
5484}
5485
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005486static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5487 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5488 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005489 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5490 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5491 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5492 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005493 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005494 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005495 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005496 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5497 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005498 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005499 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5500 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5501 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5502 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5503 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005504 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5505 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005506 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5507 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005508 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005509 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5510 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5511 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5512 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005513 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005514 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5515
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005516 case BuiltinType::Float128:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005517 case BuiltinType::Half:
5518 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5519 return ' ';
5520
5521 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5522 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5523 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5524 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5525
5526 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00005527#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
5528 case BuiltinType::Id:
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00005529#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005530 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00005531 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
5532 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
5533 case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange:
5534 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005535 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005536 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5537#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5538#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5539 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5540#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5541 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005542 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005543 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005544}
5545
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005546static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5547 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5548
5549 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5550 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5551 return 'i';
5552
5553 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005554 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5555 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005556}
5557
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005558static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005559 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005560 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005561 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005562 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5563 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5564 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5565 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5566 //
5567 // struct
5568 // {
5569 // int integer;
5570 // int flags:2;
5571 // };
5572 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5573 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5574 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5575 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5576 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005577 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005578 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5579 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005580 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005581 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5582 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005583 else {
5584 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5585 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5586 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005587 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005588 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005589}
5590
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005591// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005592void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5593 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5594 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005595 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005596 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005597 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005598 bool StructField,
5599 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005600 bool EncodeClassNames,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005601 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5602 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005603 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5604 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5605 case Type::Builtin:
5606 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005607 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005608 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005609 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5610 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5611 else
5612 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005613 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005614
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005615 case Type::Complex: {
5616 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005617 S += 'j';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005618 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005619 return;
5620 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005621
5622 case Type::Atomic: {
5623 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5624 S += 'A';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005625 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005626 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005627 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005628
5629 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5630 case Type::Pointer:
5631 case Type::LValueReference:
5632 case Type::RValueReference: {
5633 QualType PointeeTy;
5634 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5635 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5636 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5637 S += ':';
5638 return;
5639 }
5640 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5641 } else {
5642 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5643 }
5644
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005645 bool isReadOnly = false;
5646 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5647 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5648 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005649 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005650 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005651 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5652 isReadOnly = true;
5653 S += 'r';
5654 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005655 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005656 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005657 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5658 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005659 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5660 isReadOnly = true;
5661 S += 'r';
5662 }
5663 }
5664 if (isReadOnly) {
5665 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5666 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5667 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005668 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005669 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005670 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005671
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005672 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5673 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5674 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005675 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005676 S += '*';
5677 return;
5678 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005679 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005680 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5681 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5682 S += '#';
5683 return;
5684 }
5685 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5686 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5687 S += '@';
5688 return;
5689 }
5690 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005691 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005692 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005693 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5694
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005695 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005696 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
5697 NotEncodedT);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005698 return;
5699 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005700
5701 case Type::ConstantArray:
5702 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5703 case Type::VariableArray: {
5704 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5705
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005706 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005707 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5708 S += '^';
5709
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005710 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005711 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5712 } else {
5713 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005714
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005715 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5716 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5717 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005718 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005719 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5720 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005721 S += '0';
5722 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005723
5724 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005725 false, ExpandStructures, FD,
5726 false, false, false, false, false, false,
5727 NotEncodedT);
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005728 S += ']';
5729 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005730 return;
5731 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005732
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005733 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5734 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005735 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005736 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005737
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005738 case Type::Record: {
5739 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005740 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005741 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5742 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5743 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005744 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5745 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5746 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005747 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5748 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00005749 TemplateArgs.asArray(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005750 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005751 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005752 } else {
5753 S += '?';
5754 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005755 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005756 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005757 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005758 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005759 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005760 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005761 if (FD) {
5762 S += '"';
5763 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5764 S += '"';
5765 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005766
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005767 // Special case bit-fields.
5768 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5769 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005770 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005771 } else {
5772 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5773 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5774 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5775 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5776 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005777 /*StructField*/true,
5778 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005779 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005780 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005781 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005782 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005783 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005784 return;
5785 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005786
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005787 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5788 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005789 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005790 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005791 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005792
5793 S += '<';
5794 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005795 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5796 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5797 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005798 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
5799 NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005800 // Block self
5801 S += "@?";
5802 // Block parameters
5803 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00005804 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5805 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5806 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5807 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005808 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
5809 false, NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005810 }
5811 S += '>';
5812 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005813 return;
5814 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005815
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00005816 case Type::ObjCObject: {
5817 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5818 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5819 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5820 S += "{objc_object=}";
5821 return;
5822 }
5823 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5824 S += "{objc_class=}";
5825 return;
5826 }
5827 }
5828
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005829 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5830 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005831 // @encode(class_name)
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00005832 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005833 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005834 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005835 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005836 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005837 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5838 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005839 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005840 if (Field->isBitField())
5841 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005842 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005843 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5844 false, false, false, false, false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005845 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5846 NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005847 }
5848 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005849 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005850 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005851
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005852 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5853 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005854 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5855 S += '@';
5856 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005857 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005858
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005859 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5860 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5861 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5862 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005863 S += '#';
5864 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005865 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005866
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005867 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005868 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005869 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5870 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005871 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005872 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5873 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005874 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005875 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005876 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005877 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005878 S += '>';
5879 }
5880 S += '"';
5881 }
5882 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005883 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005884
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005885 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5886 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005887 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5888 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005889 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005890 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005891 // {...};
5892 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005893 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005894 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005895 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5896 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5897 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5898 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5899 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5900 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005901 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005902 S += '}';
5903 return;
5904 }
5905 }
5906 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005907 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5908 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005909 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005910 false, false, false, false, false,
5911 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005912 return;
5913 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005914
5915 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005916 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5917 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005918 S += '"';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005919 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005920 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005921 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005922 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005923 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005924 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005925 S += '"';
5926 }
5927 return;
5928 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005929
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005930 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005931 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5932 case Type::MemberPointer:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005933 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
5934 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005935 case Type::Vector:
5936 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005937 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
5938 { if (NotEncodedT)
5939 *NotEncodedT = T;
5940 return;
5941 }
5942
5943 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5944 // Just ignore it.
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005945 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005946 return;
5947
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00005948 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005949#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5950#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5951#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5952 case Type::KIND:
5953#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5954 case Type::KIND:
5955#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5956 case Type::KIND:
5957#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5958 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005959 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005960 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005961}
5962
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005963void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5964 std::string &S,
5965 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005966 bool includeVBases,
5967 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005968 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5969 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
Argyrios Kyrtzidis785705b2016-01-16 00:20:02 +00005970 if (!RDecl->getDefinition() || RDecl->getDefinition()->isInvalidDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005971 return;
5972
5973 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5974 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5975 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5976
5977 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00005978 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5979 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5980 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005981 if (base->isEmpty())
5982 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005983 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005984 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5985 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5986 }
5987 }
5988 }
5989
5990 unsigned i = 0;
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00005991 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005992 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5993 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00005994 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
5995 ++i;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005996 }
5997
5998 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00005999 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
6000 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006001 if (base->isEmpty())
6002 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00006003 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00006004 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
6005 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00006006 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
6007 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006008 }
6009 }
6010
6011 CharUnits size;
6012 if (CXXRec) {
6013 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
6014 } else {
6015 size = layout.getSize();
6016 }
6017
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006018#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006019 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006020#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006021 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
6022 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
6023
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00006024 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
6025 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006026 if (FD) {
6027 S += "\"_vptr$";
6028 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
6029 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
6030 S += recname;
6031 S += '"';
6032 }
6033 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006034#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006035 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006036#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006037 }
6038
6039 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
6040 // Mark the end of the structure.
6041 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
6042 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006043 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006044 }
6045
6046 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006047#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006048 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006049 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
6050 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
6051 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
6052 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
6053 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
6054 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
6055 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
6056 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
6057 // longer then though.
6058 CurOffs += padding;
6059 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006060#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006061
6062 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006063 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006064 break; // reached end of structure.
6065
6066 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
6067 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
6068 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
6069 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
6070 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006071 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
6072 NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006073 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006074#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006075 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006076#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006077 } else {
6078 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
6079 if (FD) {
6080 S += '"';
6081 S += field->getNameAsString();
6082 S += '"';
6083 }
6084
6085 if (field->isBitField()) {
6086 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006087#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006088 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006089#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006090 } else {
6091 QualType qt = field->getType();
6092 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6093 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
6094 /*OutermostType*/false,
6095 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006096 /*StructField*/true,
6097 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006098#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006099 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006100#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006101 }
6102 }
6103 }
6104}
6105
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006106void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00006107 std::string& S) const {
6108 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
6109 S += 'n';
6110 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
6111 S += 'N';
6112 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
6113 S += 'o';
6114 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
6115 S += 'O';
6116 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
6117 S += 'R';
6118 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
6119 S += 'V';
6120}
6121
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006122TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
6123 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00006124 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, { }, { });
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006125 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006126 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006127 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006128 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00006129}
6130
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006131TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
6132 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006133 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
6134 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006135 }
6136 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00006137}
6138
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006139TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
6140 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00006141 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, { }, { });
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006142 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006143 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006144 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006145 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00006146}
6147
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006148ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
6149 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
6150 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
6151 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6152 SourceLocation(),
6153 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Douglas Gregor85f3f952015-07-07 03:57:15 +00006154 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006155 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006156 SourceLocation(), true);
6157 }
6158
6159 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
6160}
6161
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006162//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6163// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
6164//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6165
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006166static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6167 StringRef Name) {
6168 // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006169 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006170 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name);
6171}
6172
6173static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6174 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list");
6175}
6176
6177static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6178 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006179}
6180
6181static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6182 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006183 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6184 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006185}
6186
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006187static TypedefDecl *
6188CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006189 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006190 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006191 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6192 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6193 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6194 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6195 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006196 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006197 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006198 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006199 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006200 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006201 }
6202
6203 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6204
6205 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6206 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6207 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6208
6209 // void *__stack;
6210 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6211 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
6212
6213 // void *__gr_top;
6214 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6215 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
6216
6217 // void *__vr_top;
6218 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6219 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
6220
6221 // int __gr_offs;
6222 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
6223 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
6224
6225 // int __vr_offs;
6226 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
6227 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
6228
6229 // Create fields
6230 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6231 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6232 VaListTagDecl,
6233 SourceLocation(),
6234 SourceLocation(),
6235 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006236 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6237 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006238 /*Mutable=*/false,
6239 ICIS_NoInit);
6240 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6241 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6242 }
6243 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006244 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006245 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006246
6247 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006248 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006249}
6250
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006251static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6252 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6253 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6254
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006255 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006256 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6257
6258 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6259 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6260 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6261
6262 // unsigned char gpr;
6263 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6264 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
6265
6266 // unsigned char fpr;
6267 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6268 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
6269
6270 // unsigned short reserved;
6271 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
6272 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
6273
6274 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6275 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6276 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
6277
6278 // void* reg_save_area;
6279 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6280 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
6281
6282 // Create fields
6283 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6284 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
6285 SourceLocation(),
6286 SourceLocation(),
6287 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006288 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6289 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006290 /*Mutable=*/false,
6291 ICIS_NoInit);
6292 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6293 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6294 }
6295 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006296 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006297 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6298
6299 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006300 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6301 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6302
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006303 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6304 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6305
6306 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6307 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6308 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6309 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6310 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006311 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006312}
6313
6314static TypedefDecl *
6315CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006316 // struct __va_list_tag {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006317 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006318 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006319 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6320
6321 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6322 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6323 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6324
6325 // unsigned gp_offset;
6326 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6327 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
6328
6329 // unsigned fp_offset;
6330 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6331 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
6332
6333 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6334 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6335 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
6336
6337 // void* reg_save_area;
6338 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6339 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
6340
6341 // Create fields
6342 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6343 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6344 VaListTagDecl,
6345 SourceLocation(),
6346 SourceLocation(),
6347 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006348 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6349 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006350 /*Mutable=*/false,
6351 ICIS_NoInit);
6352 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6353 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6354 }
6355 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006356 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006357 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6358
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006359 // };
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006360
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006361 // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006362 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006363 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6364 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006365 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006366}
6367
6368static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6369 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
6370 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
6371 QualType IntArrayType
6372 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
6373 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006374 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006375}
6376
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006377static TypedefDecl *
6378CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006379 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006380 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006381 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6382 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6383 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6384 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6385 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6386 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6387 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006388 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006389 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006390 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006391 }
6392
6393 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6394
6395 // void * __ap;
6396 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6397 VaListDecl,
6398 SourceLocation(),
6399 SourceLocation(),
6400 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6401 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006402 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6403 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006404 /*Mutable=*/false,
6405 ICIS_NoInit);
6406 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6407 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6408
6409 // };
6410 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
Oleg Ranevskyyb88d2472016-03-30 21:30:30 +00006411 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListDecl;
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006412
6413 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006414 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6415 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006416}
6417
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006418static TypedefDecl *
6419CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006420 // struct __va_list_tag {
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006421 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006422 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006423 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6424
6425 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6426 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6427 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6428
6429 // long __gpr;
6430 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6431 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6432
6433 // long __fpr;
6434 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6435 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6436
6437 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6438 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6439 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6440
6441 // void *__reg_save_area;
6442 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6443 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6444
6445 // Create fields
6446 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6447 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6448 VaListTagDecl,
6449 SourceLocation(),
6450 SourceLocation(),
6451 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006452 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6453 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006454 /*Mutable=*/false,
6455 ICIS_NoInit);
6456 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6457 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6458 }
6459 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006460 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006461 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006462
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006463 // };
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006464
6465 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6466 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006467 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6468 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006469
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006470 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006471}
6472
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006473static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6474 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6475 switch (Kind) {
6476 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6477 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6478 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6479 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006480 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6481 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006482 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6483 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6484 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6485 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6486 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6487 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006488 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6489 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006490 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6491 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006492 }
6493
6494 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6495}
6496
6497TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006498 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006499 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006500 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6501 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006502
6503 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6504}
6505
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006506Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const {
6507 // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006508 // declaration.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006509 if (!VaListTagDecl)
6510 (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl();
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006511
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006512 return VaListTagDecl;
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006513}
6514
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006515TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const {
6516 if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl)
6517 BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this);
6518
6519 return BuiltinMSVaListDecl;
6520}
6521
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006522void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006523 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006524 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006525
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006526 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006527}
6528
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006529/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6530/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006531TemplateName
6532ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6533 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006534 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6535 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6536
6537 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6538 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6539 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6540
6541 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006542 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006543 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6544 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6545 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6546 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6547 *Storage++ = D;
6548 }
6549
6550 return TemplateName(OT);
6551}
6552
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006553/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6554/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006555TemplateName
6556ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6557 bool TemplateKeyword,
6558 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006559 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6560
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006561 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006562 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6563 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6564
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006565 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006566 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6567 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6568 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006569 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6570 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006571 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6572 }
6573
6574 return TemplateName(QTN);
6575}
6576
6577/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6578/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006579TemplateName
6580ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6581 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006582 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006583 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006584
6585 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6586 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6587
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006588 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006589 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6590 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6591
6592 if (QTN)
6593 return TemplateName(QTN);
6594
6595 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6596 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006597 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6598 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006599 } else {
6600 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006601 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6602 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006603 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6604 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6605 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6606 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006607 }
6608
6609 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6610 return TemplateName(QTN);
6611}
6612
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006613/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6614/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6615TemplateName
6616ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006617 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006618 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6619 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6620
6621 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6622 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006623
6624 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006625 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6626 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006627
6628 if (QTN)
6629 return TemplateName(QTN);
6630
6631 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6632 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006633 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6634 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006635 } else {
6636 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006637 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6638 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006639
6640 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6641 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6642 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6643 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006644 }
6645
6646 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6647 return TemplateName(QTN);
6648}
6649
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006650TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006651ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6652 TemplateName replacement) const {
6653 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6654 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006655
6656 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006657 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6658 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6659
6660 if (!subst) {
6661 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6662 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6663 }
6664
6665 return TemplateName(subst);
6666}
6667
6668TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006669ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6670 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6671 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6672 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6673 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006674
6675 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006676 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6677 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6678
6679 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006680 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006681 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6682 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6683 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6684 }
6685
6686 return TemplateName(Subst);
6687}
6688
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006689/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006690/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6691/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006692CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006693 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006694 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00006695 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6696 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006697 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6698 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6699 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6700 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6701 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6702 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6703 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6704 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6705 }
6706
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006707 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006708}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006709
6710//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6711// Type Predicates.
6712//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6713
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006714/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6715/// garbage collection attribute.
6716///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006717Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006718 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006719 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6720
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006721 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006722 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6723
6724 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6725 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6726 // as __strong.
6727 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6728 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6729 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6730 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6731 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6732 } else {
6733 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6734 // pointer.
6735#ifndef NDEBUG
6736 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6737 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6738 CT = AT->getElementType();
6739 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6740#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006741 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006742 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006743}
6744
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006745//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6746// Type Compatibility Testing
6747//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006748
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006749/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006750/// compatible.
6751static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6752 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006753 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006754 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006755 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006756}
6757
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006758bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6759 QualType SecondVec) {
6760 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6761 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6762
6763 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6764 return true;
6765
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006766 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6767 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006768 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6769 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006770 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006771 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006772 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6773 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6774 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6775 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006776 return true;
6777
6778 return false;
6779}
6780
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006781//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6782// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6783//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6784
6785/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6786/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006787bool
6788ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6789 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006790 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006791 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00006792 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6793 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006794 return true;
6795 return false;
6796}
6797
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006798/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6799/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006800bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6801 QualType rhs) {
6802 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6803 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6804 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6805
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006806 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006807 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006808 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006809 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6810 match = true;
6811 break;
6812 }
6813 }
6814 if (!match)
6815 return false;
6816 }
6817 return true;
6818}
6819
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006820/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6821/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6822bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6823 bool compare) {
6824 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006825 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006826 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6827 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006828 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006829 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6830 return true;
6831
6832 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006833 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006834
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006835 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006836
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006837 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006838 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006839 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6840 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006841 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006842 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6843 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6844 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006845 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006846 return false;
6847 }
6848 }
6849 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6850 return true;
6851 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006852 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006853 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006854 bool match = false;
6855
6856 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6857 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6858 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006859 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006860 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6861 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6862 match = true;
6863 break;
6864 }
6865 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006866 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006867 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6868 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006869 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006870 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6871 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6872 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006873 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006874 match = true;
6875 break;
6876 }
6877 }
6878 }
6879 if (!match)
6880 return false;
6881 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006882
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006883 return true;
6884 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006885
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006886 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6887 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6888
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006889 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006890 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006891 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006892 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006893 bool match = false;
6894
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006895 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006896 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6897 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006898 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6899 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006900 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006901 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6902 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6903 match = true;
6904 break;
6905 }
6906 }
6907 if (!match)
6908 return false;
6909 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006910
6911 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6912 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6913 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6914 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6915 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6916 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6917 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6918 // assume that it is mismatch.
6919 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6920 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006921 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006922 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006923 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006924 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6925 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6926 match = true;
6927 break;
6928 }
6929 }
6930 if (!match)
6931 return false;
6932 }
6933 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006934 return true;
6935 }
6936 return false;
6937}
6938
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006939/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006940/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6941/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6942///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006943bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6944 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006945 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6946 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6947
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006948 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006949 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6950 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006951 return true;
6952
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006953 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
6954 // __kindof types.
6955 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
6956 if (succeeded)
6957 return true;
6958
6959 if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
6960 return false;
6961
6962 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
6963 // we can assign the other way.
6964 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6965 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
6966 };
6967
6968 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
6969 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6970 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6971 false));
6972 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006973
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006974 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
6975 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6976 QualType(RHSOPT,0)));
6977 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006978
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006979 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006980 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
6981 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
6982 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006983
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006984 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006985}
6986
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006987/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006988/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006989/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6990/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6991/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6992bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6993 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006994 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6995 bool BlockReturnType) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006996
6997 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
6998 // __kindof types.
6999 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
7000 if (succeeded)
7001 return true;
7002
7003 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
7004 if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
7005 return false;
7006
7007 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
7008 // we can assign the other way.
7009 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7010 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7011 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7012 BlockReturnType);
7013 };
7014
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007015 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007016 return true;
7017
7018 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007019 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
7020 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007021 }
7022
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007023 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007024 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7025 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7026 false));
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007027
7028 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7029 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7030 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
7031 if (LHS != RHS) {
7032 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007033 return finish(BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007034 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007035 return finish(!BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007036 }
7037 else
7038 return true;
7039 }
7040 return false;
7041}
7042
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007043/// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
7044/// llvm::array_pod_sort.
7045static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
7046 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
7047 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
7048
7049}
7050
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007051/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007052/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
7053/// the given common base.
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007054/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
7055/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
7056static
7057void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007058 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007059 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7060 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007061 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007062
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007063 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7064 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7065 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
7066 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007067
7068 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
7069 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
7070
7071 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7072 for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) {
7073 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007074 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007075
7076 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
7077 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
7078
7079 // Add all of the protocls for the RHS.
7080 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
7081
7082 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7083 for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) {
7084 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007085 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007086
7087 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
7088 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
7089
7090 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
7091 for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
7092 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
7093 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
7094 }
7095
7096 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
7097 // the protocols within the intersection.
7098 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
7099 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
7100
7101 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
7102 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
7103 IntersectionSet.erase(
7104 std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(),
7105 IntersectionSet.end(),
7106 [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
7107 return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0;
7108 }),
7109 IntersectionSet.end());
7110 }
7111
7112 // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
7113 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
7114 compareObjCProtocolsByName);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007115}
7116
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007117/// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
7118static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
7119 QualType rhs) {
7120 // Common case: two object pointers.
7121 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7122 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7123 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
7124 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
7125
7126 // Two block pointers.
7127 const BlockPointerType *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7128 const BlockPointerType *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7129 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
7130 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
7131
7132 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
7133 // acceptable.
7134 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
7135 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
7136 return true;
7137
7138 return false;
7139}
7140
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007141// Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007142static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
7143 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
7144 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007145 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
7146 bool stripKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007147 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
7148 return false;
7149
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007150 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007151 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007152 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7153 continue;
7154
7155 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
7156 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007157 if (!stripKindOf ||
7158 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
7159 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
7160 return false;
7161 }
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007162 break;
7163
7164 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
7165 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7166 return false;
7167 break;
7168
7169 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
7170 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
7171 return false;
7172 break;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007173 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007174 }
7175
7176 return true;
7177}
7178
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007179QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007180 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
7181 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007182 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
7183 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
7184 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
7185 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007186
7187 if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007188 return QualType();
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007189
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007190 // When either LHS or RHS is a kindof type, we should return a kindof type.
7191 // For example, for common base of kindof(ASub1) and kindof(ASub2), we return
7192 // kindof(A).
7193 bool anyKindOf = LHS->isKindOfType() || RHS->isKindOfType();
7194
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007195 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
7196 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
7197 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
7198 LHSAncestors;
7199 while (true) {
7200 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
7201 // path from the LHS to the root.
7202 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007203
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007204 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
7205 // Get the type arguments.
7206 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7207 bool anyChanges = false;
7208 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7209 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007210 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7211 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007212 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007213 return QualType();
7214 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7215 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7216 // arguments.
7217 LHSTypeArgs = { };
7218 anyChanges = true;
7219 }
7220
7221 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007222 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007223 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7224 Protocols);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007225 if (!Protocols.empty())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007226 anyChanges = true;
7227
7228 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007229 // If we need to return a kindof type but LHS is not a kindof type, we
7230 // build a new result type.
7231 if (anyChanges || LHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007232 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007233 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007234 anyKindOf || LHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007235 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7236 }
7237
7238 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007239 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007240
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007241 // Find the superclass.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007242 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
7243 if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
7244 break;
7245
7246 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7247 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007248
7249 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
7250 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
7251 while (true) {
7252 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
7253 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
7254 LHS = KnownLHS->second;
7255
7256 // Get the type arguments.
7257 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7258 bool anyChanges = false;
7259 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7260 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007261 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7262 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007263 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007264 return QualType();
7265 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7266 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7267 // arguments.
7268 RHSTypeArgs = { };
7269 anyChanges = true;
7270 }
7271
7272 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
7273 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
7274 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7275 Protocols);
7276 if (!Protocols.empty())
7277 anyChanges = true;
7278
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007279 // If we need to return a kindof type but RHS is not a kindof type, we
7280 // build a new result type.
7281 if (anyChanges || RHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007282 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007283 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007284 anyKindOf || RHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007285 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7286 }
7287
7288 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
7289 }
7290
7291 // Find the superclass of the RHS.
7292 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
7293 if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
7294 break;
7295
7296 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7297 }
7298
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007299 return QualType();
7300}
7301
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007302bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
7303 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
7304 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
7305 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
7306
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007307 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
7308 // the LHS.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007309 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
7310 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
7311 if (!IsSuperClass)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007312 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007313
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007314 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
7315 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
7316 // LHS).
7317 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007318 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
7319 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
7320 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
7321 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
7322 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
7323 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
7324 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
7325 // qualifiers.
7326 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007327 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007328 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
7329 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00007330 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007331
7332 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
7333 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
7334 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
7335 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
7336 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
7337 break;
7338 }
7339 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
7340 return false;
7341 }
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007342 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007343
7344 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
7345 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
7346 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
7347 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
7348 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
7349 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
7350 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7351
7352 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007353 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007354 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7355 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007356 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007357 return false;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007358 }
7359 }
7360
7361 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007362}
7363
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007364bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7365 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007366 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7367 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007368
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007369 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007370 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007371
7372 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
7373 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007374}
7375
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00007376bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
7377 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
7378 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7379 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
7380}
7381
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007382/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007383/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007384/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007385/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007386bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
7387 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007388 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007389 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
7390
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007391 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007392}
7393
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00007394bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00007395 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00007396}
7397
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007398bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7399 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
7400}
7401
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007402/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
7403/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
7404/// QualType()
7405QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
7406 bool OfBlockPointer,
7407 bool Unqualified) {
7408 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
7409 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
7410 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00007411 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
7412 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007413 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7414 if (!MT.isNull())
7415 return MT;
7416 }
7417 }
7418 }
7419
7420 return QualType();
7421}
7422
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007423/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
7424/// parameter types
7425QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7426 bool OfBlockPointer,
7427 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007428 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
7429 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
7430 // type is compatible with a union member
7431 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
7432 Unqualified);
7433 if (!lmerge.isNull())
7434 return lmerge;
7435
7436 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
7437 Unqualified);
7438 if (!rmerge.isNull())
7439 return rmerge;
7440
7441 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7442}
7443
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007444QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007445 bool OfBlockPointer,
7446 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007447 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
7448 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007449 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
7450 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007451 bool allLTypes = true;
7452 bool allRTypes = true;
7453
7454 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007455 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007456 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007457 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
7458 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007459 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
7460 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
7461 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007462 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007463 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007464 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007465 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007466 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007467 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007468
7469 if (Unqualified)
7470 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
7471
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007472 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
7473 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007474 if (Unqualified) {
7475 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7476 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7477 }
7478
7479 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007480 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007481 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007482 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007483
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00007484 // FIXME: double check this
7485 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7486 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7487 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00007488 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
7489 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007490
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007491 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007492 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007493 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007494
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007495 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00007496 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
7497 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007498 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
7499 return QualType();
7500
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007501 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
7502 return QualType();
7503
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007504 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
7505 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007506
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00007507 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7508 allLTypes = false;
7509 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7510 allRTypes = false;
7511
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007512 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007513
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007514 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007515 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
7516 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007517 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
7518 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007519 return QualType();
7520
7521 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
7522 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
7523 return QualType();
7524
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00007525 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
7526 return QualType();
7527
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00007528 if (!doFunctionTypesMatchOnExtParameterInfos(rproto, lproto))
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007529 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007530
7531 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007532 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007533 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
7534 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7535 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7536 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
7537 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7538 if (paramType.isNull())
7539 return QualType();
7540
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007541 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007542 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
7543
7544 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007545 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007546 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7547 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007548 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007549
7550 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007551 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007552 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007553 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007554 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007555
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007556 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7557 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007558
7559 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7560 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007561 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007562 }
7563
7564 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7565 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7566
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007567 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007568 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007569 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007570 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7571 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7572 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7573 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7574 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7575 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007576 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
7577 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007578
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007579 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007580 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007581 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7582 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7583 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007584 return QualType();
7585 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007586
7587 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7588 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007589 return QualType();
7590 }
7591
7592 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7593 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007594
7595 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7596 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007597 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007598 }
7599
7600 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7601 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007602 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007603}
7604
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007605/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7606static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7607 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7608 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7609 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7610 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7611 // type.
7612 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7613 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7614 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7615 return other;
7616
7617 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7618 // integral type of the same size.
7619 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7620 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7621 return other;
7622
7623 return QualType();
7624}
7625
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007626QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007627 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007628 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007629 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7630 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7631 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007632 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7633 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007634 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7635 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007636
7637 if (Unqualified) {
7638 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7639 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7640 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007641
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007642 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7643 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7644
7645 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7646 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7647 return LHS;
7648
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007649 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007650 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7651 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007652 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
Yaxun Liua1a87ad2016-04-12 19:43:36 +00007653 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
Yaxun Liuab933942016-04-28 17:34:57 +00007654 if (LHSCan.getUnqualifiedType() != RHSCan.getUnqualifiedType() ||
Yaxun Liua1a87ad2016-04-12 19:43:36 +00007655 LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers())
7656 return QualType();
7657 if (LQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(RQuals))
7658 return LHS;
7659 if (RQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(LQuals))
7660 return RHS;
7661 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007662 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7663 // mismatch.
7664 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007665 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7666 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007667 return QualType();
7668
7669 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7670 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7671 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7672 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7673 // qualified __strong.
7674 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7675 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7676 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7677
7678 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7679 return QualType();
7680
7681 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7682 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7683 }
7684 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7685 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7686 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007687 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007688 }
7689
7690 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007691
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007692 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7693 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007694
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007695 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7696 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7697 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7698 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007699
7700 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007701 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7702 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7703 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7704 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007705
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007706 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7707 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7708 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7709
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007710 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7711 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7712 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007713
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007714 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007715 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007716 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7717 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007718 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007719 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007720 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007721 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007722 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007723 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007724 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007725 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7726 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7727 return LHS;
7728 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7729 return RHS;
7730 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007731
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007732 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007733 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007734
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007735 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007736 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007737#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7738#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007739#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007740#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7741#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7742#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007743 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007744
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007745 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007746 case Type::LValueReference:
7747 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007748 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007749 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007750
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007751 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007752 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7753 case Type::VariableArray:
7754 case Type::FunctionProto:
7755 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007756 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007757
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007758 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007759 {
7760 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007761 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7762 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007763 if (Unqualified) {
7764 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7765 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7766 }
7767 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7768 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007769 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007770 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007771 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007772 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007773 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007774 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7775 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007776 case Type::BlockPointer:
7777 {
7778 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007779 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7780 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007781 if (Unqualified) {
7782 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7783 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7784 }
7785 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7786 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007787 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7788 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7789 return LHS;
7790 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7791 return RHS;
7792 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7793 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007794 case Type::Atomic:
7795 {
7796 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7797 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7798 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7799 if (Unqualified) {
7800 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7801 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7802 }
7803 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7804 Unqualified);
7805 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7806 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7807 return LHS;
7808 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7809 return RHS;
7810 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7811 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007812 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007813 {
7814 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7815 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7816 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7817 return QualType();
7818
7819 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7820 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007821 if (Unqualified) {
7822 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7823 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7824 }
7825
7826 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007827 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007828 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7829 return LHS;
7830 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7831 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007832 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7833 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7834 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7835 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007836 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7837 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007838 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7839 return LHS;
7840 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7841 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007842 if (LVAT) {
7843 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7844 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7845 // has to be different.
7846 return LHS;
7847 }
7848 if (RVAT) {
7849 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7850 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7851 // has to be different.
7852 return RHS;
7853 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007854 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7855 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007856 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7857 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007858 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007859 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007860 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007861 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007862 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007863 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007864 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007865 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007866 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007867 case Type::Complex:
7868 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7869 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007870 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007871 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007872 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7873 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007874 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007875 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007876 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7877 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007878 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7879 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007880 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7881 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7882 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007883 return LHS;
7884
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007885 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007886 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007887 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007888 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7889 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7890 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007891 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7892 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007893 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007894 return QualType();
7895 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007896 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7897 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007898 return LHS;
7899
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007900 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007901 }
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00007902 case Type::Pipe:
7903 {
7904 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7905 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<PipeType>()->getElementType();
7906 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<PipeType>()->getElementType();
7907 if (Unqualified) {
7908 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7909 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7910 }
7911 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7912 Unqualified);
7913 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7914 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7915 return LHS;
7916 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7917 return RHS;
7918 return getPipeType(ResultType);
7919 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007920 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007921
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007922 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007923}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007924
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00007925bool ASTContext::doFunctionTypesMatchOnExtParameterInfos(
7926 const FunctionProtoType *firstFnType,
7927 const FunctionProtoType *secondFnType) {
7928 // Fast path: if the first type doesn't have ext parameter infos,
7929 // we match if and only if they second type also doesn't have them.
7930 if (!firstFnType->hasExtParameterInfos())
7931 return !secondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
7932
7933 // Otherwise, we can only match if the second type has them.
7934 if (!secondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007935 return false;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00007936
7937 auto firstEPI = firstFnType->getExtParameterInfos();
7938 auto secondEPI = secondFnType->getExtParameterInfos();
7939 assert(firstEPI.size() == secondEPI.size());
7940
7941 for (size_t i = 0, n = firstEPI.size(); i != n; ++i) {
7942 if (firstEPI[i] != secondEPI[i])
7943 return false;
7944 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007945 return true;
7946}
7947
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00007948void ASTContext::ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl *CD) {
7949 ObjCLayouts[CD] = nullptr;
7950}
7951
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007952/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7953/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7954/// return types.
7955QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7956 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7957 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7958 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7959 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7960 return LHS;
7961 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7962 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7963 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007964 QualType OldReturnType =
7965 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007966 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007967 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007968 QualType ResReturnType =
7969 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7970 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7971 return QualType();
7972 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7973 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7974 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7975 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7976 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007977 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7978 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007979 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007980 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007981 return ResultType;
7982 }
7983 }
7984 return QualType();
7985 }
7986
7987 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7988 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7989 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7990 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7991 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7992 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7993 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7994 return QualType();
7995
7996 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7997 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7998 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7999 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
8000 // qualified __strong.
8001 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8002 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8003 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
8004
8005 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
8006 return QualType();
8007
8008 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
8009 return LHS;
8010 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
8011 return RHS;
8012 return QualType();
8013 }
8014
8015 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8016 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8017 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8018 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
8019 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
8020 return LHS;
8021 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
8022 return RHS;
8023 }
8024 return QualType();
8025}
8026
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00008027//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008028// Integer Predicates
8029//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00008030
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008031unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00008032 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00008033 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00008034 if (T->isBooleanType())
8035 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00008036 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008037 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
8038}
8039
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00008040QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00008041 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008042
8043 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
8044 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
8045 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008046 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008047
8048 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
8049 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008050 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008051
8052 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8053 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008054 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
8055 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
8056 case BuiltinType::SChar:
8057 return UnsignedCharTy;
8058 case BuiltinType::Short:
8059 return UnsignedShortTy;
8060 case BuiltinType::Int:
8061 return UnsignedIntTy;
8062 case BuiltinType::Long:
8063 return UnsignedLongTy;
8064 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
8065 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00008066 case BuiltinType::Int128:
8067 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008068 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008069 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008070 }
8071}
8072
Angel Garcia Gomez637d1e62015-10-20 13:23:58 +00008073ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00008074
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00008075void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
8076 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008077
8078//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8079// Builtin Type Computation
8080//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8081
8082/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008083/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
8084/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
8085/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
8086/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008087///
8088/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
8089/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008090static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008091 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008092 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008093 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008094 // Modifiers.
8095 int HowLong = 0;
8096 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008097 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008098
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008099 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008100 bool Done = false;
8101 while (!Done) {
8102 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008103 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008104 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008105 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008106 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008107 case 'S':
8108 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
8109 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
8110 Signed = true;
8111 break;
8112 case 'U':
8113 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008114 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008115 Unsigned = true;
8116 break;
8117 case 'L':
8118 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
8119 ++HowLong;
8120 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008121 case 'W':
8122 // This modifier represents int64 type.
8123 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
8124 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
8125 default:
8126 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
8127 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
8128 HowLong = 1;
8129 break;
8130 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
8131 HowLong = 2;
8132 break;
8133 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008134 }
8135 }
8136
8137 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008138
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008139 // Read the base type.
8140 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008141 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008142 case 'v':
8143 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8144 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
8145 Type = Context.VoidTy;
8146 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008147 case 'h':
8148 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008149 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008150 Type = Context.HalfTy;
8151 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008152 case 'f':
8153 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8154 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
8155 Type = Context.FloatTy;
8156 break;
8157 case 'd':
8158 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8159 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
8160 if (HowLong)
8161 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
8162 else
8163 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
8164 break;
8165 case 's':
8166 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
8167 if (Unsigned)
8168 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
8169 else
8170 Type = Context.ShortTy;
8171 break;
8172 case 'i':
8173 if (HowLong == 3)
8174 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
8175 else if (HowLong == 2)
8176 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
8177 else if (HowLong == 1)
8178 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
8179 else
8180 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
8181 break;
8182 case 'c':
8183 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
8184 if (Signed)
8185 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
8186 else if (Unsigned)
8187 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
8188 else
8189 Type = Context.CharTy;
8190 break;
8191 case 'b': // boolean
8192 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
8193 Type = Context.BoolTy;
8194 break;
8195 case 'z': // size_t.
8196 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
8197 Type = Context.getSizeType();
8198 break;
8199 case 'F':
8200 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
8201 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00008202 case 'G':
8203 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
8204 break;
8205 case 'H':
8206 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
8207 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00008208 case 'M':
8209 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
8210 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008211 case 'a':
8212 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8213 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
8214 break;
8215 case 'A':
8216 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
8217 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
8218 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
8219 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
8220 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
8221 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
8222 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
8223 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
8224 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8225 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008226 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008227 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008228 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008229 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008230 break;
8231 case 'V': {
8232 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008233 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8234 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008235 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008236
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008237 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
8238 RequiresICE, false);
8239 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008240
8241 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00008242 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008243 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008244 break;
8245 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00008246 case 'E': {
8247 char *End;
8248
8249 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8250 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
8251
8252 Str = End;
8253
8254 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8255 false);
8256 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
8257 break;
8258 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00008259 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008260 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8261 false);
8262 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00008263 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
8264 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00008265 }
8266 case 'Y' : {
8267 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
8268 break;
8269 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00008270 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00008271 Type = Context.getFILEType();
8272 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008273 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008274 return QualType();
8275 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008276 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00008277 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008278 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00008279 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008280 else
8281 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
8282
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008283 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008284 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008285 return QualType();
8286 }
8287 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00008288 case 'K':
8289 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
8290 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
8291
8292 if (Type.isNull()) {
8293 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
8294 return QualType();
8295 }
8296 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00008297 case 'p':
8298 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
8299 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00008300 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008301
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008302 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
8303 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008304 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00008305 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008306 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
8307 case '*':
8308 case '&': {
8309 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
8310 // qualified with an address space.
8311 char *End;
8312 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8313 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
8314 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
8315 Str = End;
8316 }
8317 if (c == '*')
8318 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
8319 else
8320 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
8321 break;
8322 }
8323 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
8324 case 'C':
8325 Type = Type.withConst();
8326 break;
8327 case 'D':
8328 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
8329 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00008330 case 'R':
8331 Type = Type.withRestrict();
8332 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008333 }
8334 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008335
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008336 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008337 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008338
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008339 return Type;
8340}
8341
8342/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008343QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008344 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008345 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Eric Christopher02d5d862015-08-06 01:01:12 +00008346 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008347
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008348 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008349
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008350 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008351 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008352 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
8353 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008354 if (Error != GE_None)
8355 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008356
8357 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
8358
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008359 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008360 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008361 if (Error != GE_None)
8362 return QualType();
8363
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008364 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
8365 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
8366 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
8367 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
8368
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008369 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
8370 if (Ty->isArrayType())
8371 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008372
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008373 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
8374 }
8375
David Majnemerba3e5ec2015-03-13 18:26:17 +00008376 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
8377 return QualType();
8378
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008379 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
8380 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
8381
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008382 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00008383 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
8384
8385 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
8386
8387 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
8388 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
8389 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00008390
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008391 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00008392 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
8393 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008394
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00008395 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008396}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00008397
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008398static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
8399 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008400 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008401 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008402
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008403 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8404 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
8405 case TSK_Undeclared:
8406 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
8407 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8408 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008409
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008410 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008411 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008412
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00008413 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
8414 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
8415 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
8416 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
8417 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
8418 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008419 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008420 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8421
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008422 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008423 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008424 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008425 }
8426
8427 if (!FD->isInlined())
8428 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00008429
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00008430 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
8431 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008432 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00008433 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008434 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
8435
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008436 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
8437 // externally visible.
8438 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
8439 return External;
8440
8441 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008442 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008443 }
8444
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008445 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
8446 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
8447 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
David Majnemer73768702015-03-20 00:02:27 +00008448 if (FD->isMSExternInline())
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008449 return GVA_StrongODR;
8450
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008451 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008452}
8453
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008454static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(const ASTContext &Context,
8455 GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008456 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
8457 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
8458 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
8459 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
8460 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008461 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008462 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
8463 return GVA_StrongODR;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008464 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice &&
8465 D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) {
8466 // Device-side functions with __global__ attribute must always be
8467 // visible externally so they can be launched from host.
8468 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_Internal)
8469 return GVA_StrongODR;
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008470 }
8471 return L;
8472}
8473
8474GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008475 return adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(
8476 *this, basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD), FD);
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008477}
8478
8479static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
8480 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008481 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
8482 return GVA_Internal;
8483
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008484 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
8485 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
8486 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
8487 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
8488 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
8489
Richard Smith9e2341d2015-03-23 03:25:59 +00008490 // Let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the nearest
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008491 // enclosing function.
8492 if (LexicalContext)
8493 StaticLocalLinkage =
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008494 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008495
8496 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
8497 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
8498 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
8499 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
8500 : StaticLocalLinkage;
8501 }
8502
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008503 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
8504 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
8505 // cause link errors.
8506 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
8507 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8508
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00008509 // Most non-template variables have strong linkage; inline variables are
8510 // linkonce_odr or (occasionally, for compatibility) weak_odr.
8511 GVALinkage StrongLinkage;
8512 switch (Context.getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(VD)) {
8513 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None:
8514 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongExternal;
8515 break;
8516 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak:
8517 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008518 StrongLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00008519 break;
8520 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong:
8521 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongODR;
8522 break;
8523 }
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008524
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00008525 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008526 case TSK_Undeclared:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008527 return StrongLinkage;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008528
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008529 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00008530 return Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
8531 VD->isStaticDataMember()
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008532 ? GVA_StrongODR
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008533 : StrongLinkage;
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008534
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008535 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008536 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008537
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008538 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
8539 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8540
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008541 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008542 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008543 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00008544
8545 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008546}
8547
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008548GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008549 return adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(
8550 *this, basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD), VD);
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008551}
8552
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00008553bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008554 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
8555 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
8556 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00008557 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
8558 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
8559 return false;
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00008560 if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
8561 isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
8562 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00008563 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8564 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
8565 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
8566 return false;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00008567 } else if (isa<PragmaCommentDecl>(D))
8568 return true;
Dmitry Polukhin0b0da292016-04-06 11:38:59 +00008569 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D) ||
8570 D->hasAttr<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr>())
8571 return true;
Nico Webercbbaeb12016-03-02 19:28:54 +00008572 else if (isa<PragmaDetectMismatchDecl>(D))
8573 return true;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00008574 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
Alexey Bataevc5b1d322016-03-04 09:22:22 +00008575 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
8576 else if (isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(D))
8577 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
Alexey Bataev97720002014-11-11 04:05:39 +00008578 else
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00008579 return false;
8580
8581 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
8582 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008583 return false;
8584
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008585 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
8586 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
8587 return false;
8588
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008589 // Aliases and used decls are required.
8590 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
8591 return true;
8592
8593 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8594 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00008595 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00008596 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008597
8598 // Constructors and destructors are required.
8599 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
8600 return true;
8601
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00008602 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
8603 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
8604 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
8605 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
8606 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
8607 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
8608 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
8609 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
8610 return true;
8611 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008612 }
8613 }
8614
8615 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
8616
8617 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
8618 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
8619 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008620 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
8621 Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008622 return false;
8623 return true;
8624 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00008625
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008626 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
8627 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
8628
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008629 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
8630 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008631 return false;
8632
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008633 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008634 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00008635 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
8636 L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008637 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008638
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008639 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
8640 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
8641 return true;
8642
8643 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00008644 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) &&
8645 !VD->evaluateValue())
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008646 return true;
8647
8648 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008649}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008650
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008651CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
8652 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008653 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008654 if (IsCXXMethod)
8655 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00008656
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00008657 switch (LangOpts.getDefaultCallingConv()) {
8658 case LangOptions::DCC_None:
8659 break;
8660 case LangOptions::DCC_CDecl:
8661 return CC_C;
8662 case LangOptions::DCC_FastCall:
8663 if (getTargetInfo().hasFeature("sse2"))
8664 return CC_X86FastCall;
8665 break;
8666 case LangOptions::DCC_StdCall:
8667 if (!IsVariadic)
8668 return CC_X86StdCall;
8669 break;
8670 case LangOptions::DCC_VectorCall:
8671 // __vectorcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
8672 if (!IsVariadic)
8673 return CC_X86VectorCall;
8674 break;
8675 }
Alexander Kornienko21de0ae2015-01-20 11:20:41 +00008676 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008677}
8678
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008679bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00008680 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8681 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
8682}
8683
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00008684VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
8685 if (!VTContext.get()) {
8686 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
8687 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
8688 else
8689 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
8690 }
8691 return VTContext.get();
8692}
8693
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008694MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008695 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00008696 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008697 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
8698 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +00008699 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008700 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00008701 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +00008702 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +00008703 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008704 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008705 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008706 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008707 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008708 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008709}
8710
Angel Garcia Gomez637d1e62015-10-20 13:23:58 +00008711CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008712
8713size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00008714 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8715 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8716 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8717 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8718 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8719 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8720 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8721 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8722 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8723 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8724 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8725 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8726 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8727 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008728}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008729
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00008730/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8731/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8732/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8733/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8734QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8735 unsigned Signed) const {
8736 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8737 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8738 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8739 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8740 return QualTy;
8741}
8742
8743/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8744/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8745/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8746QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8747 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8748 switch (Ty) {
8749 case TargetInfo::Float:
8750 return FloatTy;
8751 case TargetInfo::Double:
8752 return DoubleTy;
8753 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8754 return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00008755 case TargetInfo::Float128:
8756 return Float128Ty;
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00008757 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8758 return QualType();
8759 }
8760
8761 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8762}
8763
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008764void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8765 if (Number > 1)
8766 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008767}
8768
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008769unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00008770 auto I = MangleNumbers.find(ND);
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008771 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008772}
8773
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00008774void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8775 if (Number > 1)
8776 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8777}
8778
8779unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00008780 auto I = StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00008781 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8782}
8783
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008784MangleNumberingContext &
8785ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00008786 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8787 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8788 if (!MCtx)
8789 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8790 return *MCtx;
8791}
8792
8793MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8794 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008795}
8796
David Majnemere7a818f2015-03-06 18:53:55 +00008797const CXXConstructorDecl *
8798ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
8799 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8800 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
8801}
8802
8803void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
8804 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
8805 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8806 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
8807 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
8808}
8809
David Majnemerdfa6d202015-03-11 18:36:39 +00008810void ASTContext::addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8811 unsigned ParmIdx, Expr *DAE) {
8812 ABI->addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8813 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx, DAE);
8814}
8815
8816Expr *ASTContext::getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8817 unsigned ParmIdx) {
8818 return ABI->getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8819 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx);
8820}
8821
David Majnemer00350522015-08-31 18:48:39 +00008822void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
8823 TypedefNameDecl *DD) {
8824 return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
8825}
8826
8827TypedefNameDecl *
8828ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
8829 return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
8830}
8831
8832void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
8833 DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
8834 return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
8835}
8836
8837DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
8838 return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
8839}
8840
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008841void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8842 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8843}
8844
8845unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8846 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8847 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8848 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8849 return I->second;
8850}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008851
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008852APValue *
8853ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8854 bool MayCreate) {
8855 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8856 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00008857 if (MayCreate) {
8858 APValue *&MTVI = MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8859 if (!MTVI)
8860 MTVI = new (*this) APValue;
8861 return MTVI;
8862 }
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008863
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00008864 return MaterializedTemporaryValues.lookup(E);
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008865}
8866
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008867bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8868 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8869 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8870 return false;
8871
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00008872 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8873 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8874 return false;
8875
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008876 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8877 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8878 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8879 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8880 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8881 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8882 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8883}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008884
8885namespace {
8886
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008887ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(
8888 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers::mapped_type U) {
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00008889 if (const auto *D = U.dyn_cast<const Decl *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008890 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*D);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00008891 if (const auto *S = U.dyn_cast<const Stmt *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008892 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*S);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00008893 return *U.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008894}
8895
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008896/// Template specializations to abstract away from pointers and TypeLocs.
8897/// @{
8898template <typename T>
8899ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const T &Node) {
8900 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node);
8901}
8902template <>
8903ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const TypeLoc &Node) {
8904 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
8905}
8906template <>
8907ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode
8908createDynTypedNode(const NestedNameSpecifierLoc &Node) {
8909 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
8910}
8911/// @}
8912
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008913 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8914 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8915 ///
8916 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8917 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8918 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8919 ///
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00008920 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008921 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008922 public:
8923 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8924 ///
8925 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008926 static std::pair<ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *,
8927 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *>
8928 buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8929 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMapPointers,
8930 new ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008931 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008932 return std::make_pair(Visitor.Parents, Visitor.OtherParents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008933 }
8934
8935 private:
8936 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8937
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008938 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents,
8939 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents)
8940 : Parents(Parents), OtherParents(OtherParents) {}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008941
8942 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8943 return true;
8944 }
8945 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8946 return true;
8947 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008948
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008949 template <typename T, typename MapNodeTy, typename BaseTraverseFn,
8950 typename MapTy>
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008951 bool TraverseNode(T Node, MapNodeTy MapNode,
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008952 BaseTraverseFn BaseTraverse, MapTy *Parents) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008953 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008954 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008955 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00008956 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
8957 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
8958 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
8959 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
8960 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
8961 // new matches.
8962 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8963 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8964 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8965 // do not have pointer identity.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008966 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[MapNode];
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008967 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008968 if (const auto *D = ParentStack.back().get<Decl>())
8969 NodeOrVector = D;
8970 else if (const auto *S = ParentStack.back().get<Stmt>())
8971 NodeOrVector = S;
8972 else
8973 NodeOrVector =
8974 new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008975 } else {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008976 if (!NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
8977 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(
8978 1, getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(NodeOrVector));
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008979 if (auto *Node =
8980 NodeOrVector
8981 .template dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>())
8982 delete Node;
Benjamin Kramer422b3ff2015-10-23 13:24:18 +00008983 NodeOrVector = Vector;
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008984 }
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008985
8986 auto *Vector =
8987 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
8988 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
8989 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
8990 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
8991 // types.
8992 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
8993 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
8994 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
8995 if (!Found)
8996 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008997 }
8998 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008999 ParentStack.push_back(createDynTypedNode(Node));
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009000 bool Result = BaseTraverse();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009001 ParentStack.pop_back();
9002 return Result;
9003 }
9004
9005 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009006 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, DeclNode,
9007 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseDecl(DeclNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009008 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009009 }
9010
9011 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009012 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, StmtNode,
9013 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseStmt(StmtNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009014 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009015 }
9016
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009017 bool TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLoc TypeLocNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009018 return TraverseNode(
9019 TypeLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(TypeLocNode),
9020 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLocNode); },
9021 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009022 }
9023
9024 bool TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLocNode) {
9025 return TraverseNode(
9026 NNSLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(NNSLocNode),
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009027 [&] {
9028 return VisitorBase::TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NNSLocNode);
9029 },
9030 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009031 }
9032
9033 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents;
9034 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009035 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
9036
9037 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
9038 };
9039
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00009040} // anonymous namespace
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009041
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009042template <typename NodeTy, typename MapTy>
9043static ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList getDynNodeFromMap(const NodeTy &Node,
9044 const MapTy &Map) {
9045 auto I = Map.find(Node);
9046 if (I == Map.end()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009047 return llvm::ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009048 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009049 if (auto *V = I->second.template dyn_cast<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009050 return llvm::makeArrayRef(*V);
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009051 }
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009052 return getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(I->second);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009053}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009054
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009055ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList
9056ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
9057 if (!PointerParents) {
9058 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
9059 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
9060 auto Maps = ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl());
9061 PointerParents.reset(Maps.first);
9062 OtherParents.reset(Maps.second);
9063 }
9064 if (Node.getNodeKind().hasPointerIdentity())
9065 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node.getMemoizationData(), *PointerParents);
9066 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node, *OtherParents);
9067}
9068
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009069bool
9070ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
9071 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
9072 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
9073 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
9074 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
9075 return false;
9076 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
9077 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9078 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00009079 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009080 return false;
9081
9082 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
9083 return false;
9084
9085 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
9086 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
9087 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
9088 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
9089 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
9090 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
9091 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9092 return false;
9093 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
9094 return false;
9095 }
9096 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
9097
9098}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00009099
9100// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
9101// doesn't include ASTContext.h
9102template
9103clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9104 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
9105clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9106 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
9107 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);